ef36c6939e
o) Add TARGET_ABI to the MIPS toolchain build process. This sets the default ABI to one of o32, n32 or n64. If it is not set, o32 is assumed as that is the current default. o) Set the default GCC cpu type to any specified TARGET_CPUTYPE. This is necessary to have a working "cc" if e.g. mips64 is specified, as binutils will refuse to link objects using different ISAs in some cases. o) Add support for n32 and n64 ABIs to binutils and GCC. o) Add additional required libgcc2 stubs for n32 and n64. o) Add support for the "mips64r2" architecture to GCC. Add the "octeon" o) When static linking, wrap default libraries in --start-group and --end-group. This is required for static linking to work on n64 with the interdependencies between libraries there. This is what other OSes that support n64 seem to do, as well. o) Fix our GCC spec to define __mips64 for 64-bit targets, not __mips64__, the former being what libgcc, etc., check and the latter seemingly being a misspelling of a hand merge from a Linux spec. o) When no TARGET_CPUTYPE is specified at build time, make GCC take the default ISA from the ABI. Our old defaults were too liberal and assumed that 64-bit ABIs should default to the MIPS64 ISA and that 32-bit ABIs should default to the MIPS32 ISA, when we are supporting or will support some systems based on earlier 32-bit and 64-bit ISAs, most notably MIPS-III. o) Merge a new opcode file (and support code) from a later version of binutils and add flags and code necessary to support Octeon-specific instructions. This should also make merging opcodes for other modern architectures easier. Reviewed by: imp
9268 lines
275 KiB
C
9268 lines
275 KiB
C
/* MIPS-specific support for ELF
|
||
Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
|
||
2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||
|
||
Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
|
||
<ian@cygnus.com>.
|
||
N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
|
||
<mark@codesourcery.com>
|
||
Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
|
||
Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
|
||
|
||
This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
|
||
|
||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
||
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
|
||
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
|
||
(at your option) any later version.
|
||
|
||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||
|
||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
|
||
|
||
/* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's. */
|
||
|
||
#include "bfd.h"
|
||
#include "sysdep.h"
|
||
#include "libbfd.h"
|
||
#include "libiberty.h"
|
||
#include "elf-bfd.h"
|
||
#include "elfxx-mips.h"
|
||
#include "elf/mips.h"
|
||
|
||
/* Get the ECOFF swapping routines. */
|
||
#include "coff/sym.h"
|
||
#include "coff/symconst.h"
|
||
#include "coff/ecoff.h"
|
||
#include "coff/mips.h"
|
||
|
||
#include "hashtab.h"
|
||
|
||
/* This structure is used to hold .got entries while estimating got
|
||
sizes. */
|
||
struct mips_got_entry
|
||
{
|
||
/* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */
|
||
bfd *abfd;
|
||
/* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
|
||
we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise. */
|
||
long symndx;
|
||
union
|
||
{
|
||
/* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got. */
|
||
bfd_vma address;
|
||
/* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
|
||
that should be added to the symbol value. */
|
||
bfd_vma addend;
|
||
/* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
|
||
corresponding to a global symbol in the got (or, local, if
|
||
h->forced_local). */
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
||
} d;
|
||
/* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
|
||
corresponding to this symbol+addend. If it's a global symbol
|
||
whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1. */
|
||
long gotidx;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking. */
|
||
|
||
struct mips_got_info
|
||
{
|
||
/* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
|
||
symbol table. */
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
|
||
/* The number of global .got entries. */
|
||
unsigned int global_gotno;
|
||
/* The number of local .got entries. */
|
||
unsigned int local_gotno;
|
||
/* The number of local .got entries we have used. */
|
||
unsigned int assigned_gotno;
|
||
/* A hash table holding members of the got. */
|
||
struct htab *got_entries;
|
||
/* A hash table mapping input bfds to other mips_got_info. NULL
|
||
unless multi-got was necessary. */
|
||
struct htab *bfd2got;
|
||
/* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
|
||
of the time, it points to the previous got). */
|
||
struct mips_got_info *next;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* Map an input bfd to a got in a multi-got link. */
|
||
|
||
struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash {
|
||
bfd *bfd;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* Structure passed when traversing the bfd2got hash table, used to
|
||
create and merge bfd's gots. */
|
||
|
||
struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
|
||
{
|
||
/* A hashtable that maps bfds to gots. */
|
||
htab_t bfd2got;
|
||
/* The output bfd. */
|
||
bfd *obfd;
|
||
/* The link information. */
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info;
|
||
/* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
|
||
the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
|
||
DT_MIPS_GOTSYM. */
|
||
struct mips_got_info *primary;
|
||
/* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
|
||
gots. */
|
||
struct mips_got_info *current;
|
||
/* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
|
||
16-bit offset. */
|
||
unsigned int max_count;
|
||
/* The number of local and global entries in the primary got. */
|
||
unsigned int primary_count;
|
||
/* The number of local and global entries in the current got. */
|
||
unsigned int current_count;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* Another structure used to pass arguments for got entries traversal. */
|
||
|
||
struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
int value;
|
||
unsigned int needed_relocs;
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
struct _mips_elf_section_data
|
||
{
|
||
struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
|
||
union
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_info *got_info;
|
||
bfd_byte *tdata;
|
||
} u;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
#define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
|
||
((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
|
||
|
||
/* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
|
||
the dynamic symbols. */
|
||
|
||
struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
|
||
{
|
||
/* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
|
||
index. */
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
|
||
/* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
|
||
with a GOT entry. */
|
||
long min_got_dynindx;
|
||
/* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
|
||
with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
|
||
with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs). */
|
||
long max_unref_got_dynindx;
|
||
/* The greatest dynamic symbol table index not corresponding to a
|
||
symbol without a GOT entry. */
|
||
long max_non_got_dynindx;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
|
||
the global hash table. */
|
||
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
|
||
{
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
|
||
|
||
/* External symbol information. */
|
||
EXTR esym;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
|
||
this symbol. */
|
||
unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
|
||
|
||
/* If the R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 reloc is against
|
||
a readonly section. */
|
||
bfd_boolean readonly_reloc;
|
||
|
||
/* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
|
||
related to taking the function's address, i.e. any but
|
||
R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones -- see "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition",
|
||
p. 4-20. */
|
||
bfd_boolean no_fn_stub;
|
||
|
||
/* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
|
||
16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
|
||
asection *fn_stub;
|
||
|
||
/* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is set if this symbol appears
|
||
in any relocs other than a 16 bit call. */
|
||
bfd_boolean need_fn_stub;
|
||
|
||
/* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
|
||
32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
|
||
asection *call_stub;
|
||
|
||
/* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
|
||
being called returns a floating point value. */
|
||
asection *call_fp_stub;
|
||
|
||
/* Are we forced local? .*/
|
||
bfd_boolean forced_local;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
|
||
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
|
||
{
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_table root;
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* We no longer use this. */
|
||
/* String section indices for the dynamic section symbols. */
|
||
bfd_size_type dynsym_sec_strindex[SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES];
|
||
#endif
|
||
/* The number of .rtproc entries. */
|
||
bfd_size_type procedure_count;
|
||
/* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT). */
|
||
bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
|
||
/* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic
|
||
entry is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5. */
|
||
bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
|
||
/* This is the value of the __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol. */
|
||
bfd_vma rld_value;
|
||
/* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections. */
|
||
bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym. */
|
||
|
||
struct extsym_info
|
||
{
|
||
bfd *abfd;
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info;
|
||
struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
|
||
const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
|
||
bfd_boolean failed;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5. */
|
||
|
||
static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
|
||
{
|
||
"_procedure_table",
|
||
"_procedure_string_table",
|
||
"_procedure_table_size",
|
||
NULL
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
|
||
IRIX5. */
|
||
|
||
typedef struct
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long id1; /* Always one? */
|
||
unsigned long num; /* Number of compact relocation entries. */
|
||
unsigned long id2; /* Always two? */
|
||
unsigned long offset; /* The file offset of the first relocation. */
|
||
unsigned long reserved0; /* Zero? */
|
||
unsigned long reserved1; /* Zero? */
|
||
} Elf32_compact_rel;
|
||
|
||
typedef struct
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_byte id1[4];
|
||
bfd_byte num[4];
|
||
bfd_byte id2[4];
|
||
bfd_byte offset[4];
|
||
bfd_byte reserved0[4];
|
||
bfd_byte reserved1[4];
|
||
} Elf32_External_compact_rel;
|
||
|
||
typedef struct
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
|
||
unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
|
||
unsigned int dist2to : 8;
|
||
unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
|
||
unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
|
||
unsigned long vaddr; /* VADDR to be relocated. */
|
||
} Elf32_crinfo;
|
||
|
||
typedef struct
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
|
||
unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
|
||
unsigned int dist2to : 8;
|
||
unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
|
||
unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
|
||
} Elf32_crinfo2;
|
||
|
||
typedef struct
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_byte info[4];
|
||
bfd_byte konst[4];
|
||
bfd_byte vaddr[4];
|
||
} Elf32_External_crinfo;
|
||
|
||
typedef struct
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_byte info[4];
|
||
bfd_byte konst[4];
|
||
} Elf32_External_crinfo2;
|
||
|
||
/* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo. */
|
||
|
||
#define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
|
||
#define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
|
||
#define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
|
||
#define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
|
||
#define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
|
||
#define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
|
||
#define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
|
||
#define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
|
||
|
||
/* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
|
||
formats. A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
|
||
fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2). */
|
||
#define CRF_MIPS_LONG 1
|
||
#define CRF_MIPS_SHORT 0
|
||
|
||
/* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
|
||
has different meaning for each type:
|
||
|
||
(type) (konst)
|
||
CT_MIPS_REL32 Address in data
|
||
CT_MIPS_WORD Address in word (XXX)
|
||
CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO GP - vaddr
|
||
CT_MIPS_JMPAD Address to jump
|
||
*/
|
||
|
||
#define CRT_MIPS_REL32 0xa
|
||
#define CRT_MIPS_WORD 0xb
|
||
#define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO 0xc
|
||
#define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD 0xd
|
||
|
||
#define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format) ((x).ctype = (format))
|
||
#define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type) ((x).rtype = (type))
|
||
#define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v) ((x).dist2to = (v))
|
||
#define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d) ((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
|
||
|
||
/* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
|
||
loader for use by the static exception system. */
|
||
|
||
typedef struct runtime_pdr {
|
||
bfd_vma adr; /* Memory address of start of procedure. */
|
||
long regmask; /* Save register mask. */
|
||
long regoffset; /* Save register offset. */
|
||
long fregmask; /* Save floating point register mask. */
|
||
long fregoffset; /* Save floating point register offset. */
|
||
long frameoffset; /* Frame size. */
|
||
short framereg; /* Frame pointer register. */
|
||
short pcreg; /* Offset or reg of return pc. */
|
||
long irpss; /* Index into the runtime string table. */
|
||
long reserved;
|
||
struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array. */
|
||
} RPDR, *pRPDR;
|
||
#define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
|
||
#define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
|
||
|
||
static struct bfd_hash_entry *mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc
|
||
(struct bfd_hash_entry *, struct bfd_hash_table *, const char *);
|
||
static void ecoff_swap_rpdr_out
|
||
(bfd *, const RPDR *, struct rpdr_ext *);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_procedure_table
|
||
(void *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, asection *,
|
||
struct ecoff_debug_info *);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs
|
||
(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
|
||
static void bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in
|
||
(bfd *, const Elf32_External_gptab *, Elf32_gptab *);
|
||
static void bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out
|
||
(bfd *, const Elf32_gptab *, Elf32_External_gptab *);
|
||
static void bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out
|
||
(bfd *, const Elf32_compact_rel *, Elf32_External_compact_rel *);
|
||
static void bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out
|
||
(bfd *, const Elf32_crinfo *, Elf32_External_crinfo *);
|
||
static int sort_dynamic_relocs
|
||
(const void *, const void *);
|
||
static int sort_dynamic_relocs_64
|
||
(const void *, const void *);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_output_extsym
|
||
(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
|
||
static int gptab_compare
|
||
(const void *, const void *);
|
||
static asection *mips_elf_rel_dyn_section
|
||
(bfd *, bfd_boolean);
|
||
static asection *mips_elf_got_section
|
||
(bfd *, bfd_boolean);
|
||
static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_info
|
||
(bfd *, asection **);
|
||
static long mips_elf_get_global_gotsym_index
|
||
(bfd *abfd);
|
||
static bfd_vma mips_elf_local_got_index
|
||
(bfd *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_vma);
|
||
static bfd_vma mips_elf_global_got_index
|
||
(bfd *, bfd *, struct elf_link_hash_entry *);
|
||
static bfd_vma mips_elf_got_page
|
||
(bfd *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_vma, bfd_vma *);
|
||
static bfd_vma mips_elf_got16_entry
|
||
(bfd *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_vma, bfd_boolean);
|
||
static bfd_vma mips_elf_got_offset_from_index
|
||
(bfd *, bfd *, bfd *, bfd_vma);
|
||
static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
|
||
(bfd *, bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, asection *, bfd_vma);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table
|
||
(struct bfd_link_info *, unsigned long);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
|
||
(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol
|
||
(bfd *, long, bfd_vma, struct mips_got_info *);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol
|
||
(struct elf_link_hash_entry *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *,
|
||
struct mips_got_info *);
|
||
static const Elf_Internal_Rela *mips_elf_next_relocation
|
||
(bfd *, unsigned int, const Elf_Internal_Rela *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_local_relocation_p
|
||
(bfd *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *, asection **, bfd_boolean);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_overflow_p
|
||
(bfd_vma, int);
|
||
static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
|
||
(bfd_vma);
|
||
static bfd_vma mips_elf_higher
|
||
(bfd_vma);
|
||
static bfd_vma mips_elf_highest
|
||
(bfd_vma);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
|
||
(bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_got_section
|
||
(bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_boolean);
|
||
static bfd_reloc_status_type mips_elf_calculate_relocation
|
||
(bfd *, bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *,
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd_vma, reloc_howto_type *,
|
||
Elf_Internal_Sym *, asection **, bfd_vma *, const char **,
|
||
bfd_boolean *, bfd_boolean);
|
||
static bfd_vma mips_elf_obtain_contents
|
||
(reloc_howto_type *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd *, bfd_byte *);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_perform_relocation
|
||
(struct bfd_link_info *, reloc_howto_type *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
|
||
bfd_vma, bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, bfd_boolean);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_stub_section_p
|
||
(bfd *, asection *);
|
||
static void mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations
|
||
(bfd *, unsigned int);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
|
||
(bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
|
||
bfd_vma *, asection *);
|
||
static void mips_set_isa_flags
|
||
(bfd *);
|
||
static INLINE char *elf_mips_abi_name
|
||
(bfd *);
|
||
static void mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol
|
||
(bfd *, const char *, Elf_Internal_Sym *);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_mach_extends_p
|
||
(unsigned long, unsigned long);
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_32bit_flags_p
|
||
(flagword);
|
||
static INLINE hashval_t mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma
|
||
(bfd_vma);
|
||
static hashval_t mips_elf_got_entry_hash
|
||
(const void *);
|
||
static int mips_elf_got_entry_eq
|
||
(const void *, const void *);
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean mips_elf_multi_got
|
||
(bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, struct mips_got_info *,
|
||
asection *, bfd_size_type);
|
||
static hashval_t mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash
|
||
(const void *);
|
||
static int mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq
|
||
(const void *, const void *);
|
||
static hashval_t mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash
|
||
(const void *);
|
||
static int mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq
|
||
(const void *, const void *);
|
||
static int mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd
|
||
(void **, void *);
|
||
static int mips_elf_merge_gots
|
||
(void **, void *);
|
||
static int mips_elf_set_global_got_offset
|
||
(void **, void *);
|
||
static int mips_elf_set_no_stub
|
||
(void **, void *);
|
||
static int mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry
|
||
(void **, void *);
|
||
static void mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries
|
||
(struct mips_got_info *);
|
||
static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
|
||
(bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
|
||
static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_for_ibfd
|
||
(struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
|
||
|
||
/* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records. */
|
||
static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
|
||
|
||
/* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI. */
|
||
|
||
#define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
|
||
((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
|
||
|
||
/* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI. */
|
||
#define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
|
||
(get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
|
||
|
||
/* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions. */
|
||
#define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
|
||
|
||
/* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for. */
|
||
#define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
|
||
(get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
|
||
|
||
/* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all. */
|
||
#define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
|
||
(IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
|
||
|
||
/* The name of the options section. */
|
||
#define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
|
||
(NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
|
||
|
||
/* The name of the stub section. */
|
||
#define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs"
|
||
|
||
/* The size of an external REL relocation. */
|
||
#define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
|
||
(get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
|
||
|
||
/* The size of an external dynamic table entry. */
|
||
#define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
|
||
(get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
|
||
|
||
/* The size of a GOT entry. */
|
||
#define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
|
||
(get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
|
||
|
||
/* The size of a symbol-table entry. */
|
||
#define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
|
||
(get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
|
||
|
||
/* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two. */
|
||
#define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd) \
|
||
(get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
|
||
|
||
/* Get word-sized data. */
|
||
#define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
|
||
(ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
|
||
|
||
/* Put out word-sized data. */
|
||
#define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr) \
|
||
(ABI_64_P (abfd) \
|
||
? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) \
|
||
: bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
|
||
|
||
/* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry. */
|
||
#define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \
|
||
_bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val)
|
||
|
||
#define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela) \
|
||
(get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela))
|
||
|
||
/* Determine whether the internal relocation of index REL_IDX is REL
|
||
(zero) or RELA (non-zero). The assumption is that, if there are
|
||
two relocation sections for this section, one of them is REL and
|
||
the other is RELA. If the index of the relocation we're testing is
|
||
in range for the first relocation section, check that the external
|
||
relocation size is that for RELA. It is also assumed that, if
|
||
rel_idx is not in range for the first section, and this first
|
||
section contains REL relocs, then the relocation is in the second
|
||
section, that is RELA. */
|
||
#define MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P(abfd, sec, rel_idx) \
|
||
((NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr) \
|
||
* get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel \
|
||
> (bfd_vma)(rel_idx)) \
|
||
== (elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr.sh_entsize \
|
||
== (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela) \
|
||
: sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela))))
|
||
|
||
/* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
|
||
from smaller values. Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement. */
|
||
#define MINUS_ONE (((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
|
||
|
||
/* The number of local .got entries we reserve. */
|
||
#define MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (2)
|
||
|
||
/* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section. */
|
||
#define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(abfd) (0x7ff0)
|
||
|
||
/* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
|
||
offsets from $gp. */
|
||
#define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(abfd) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(abfd) + 0x7fff)
|
||
|
||
/* Instructions which appear in a stub. */
|
||
#define STUB_LW(abfd) \
|
||
((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
|
||
? 0xdf998010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
|
||
: 0x8f998010)) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
|
||
#define STUB_MOVE(abfd) \
|
||
((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
|
||
? 0x03e0782d /* daddu t7,ra */ \
|
||
: 0x03e07821)) /* addu t7,ra */
|
||
#define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809 /* jalr t9,ra */
|
||
#define STUB_LI16(abfd) \
|
||
((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
|
||
? 0x64180000 /* daddiu t8,zero,0 */ \
|
||
: 0x24180000)) /* addiu t8,zero,0 */
|
||
#define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE (16)
|
||
|
||
/* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
|
||
section. */
|
||
|
||
#define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) \
|
||
(ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" \
|
||
: ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" \
|
||
: "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
|
||
|
||
#ifdef BFD64
|
||
#define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
|
||
(ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
|
||
#define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
|
||
(ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
|
||
#define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
|
||
(ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
|
||
#define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
|
||
(ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
|
||
#else
|
||
#define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
|
||
#define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
|
||
(ELF32_R_SYM (i))
|
||
#define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
|
||
(ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
|
||
#define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
|
||
(ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
|
||
floating point arguments.
|
||
|
||
Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
|
||
copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
|
||
then jump to FNNAME. If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
|
||
call should be redirected to the stub instead. If no 32 bit
|
||
function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded. We need to
|
||
consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
|
||
if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
|
||
since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
|
||
|
||
Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
|
||
that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
|
||
regs and then jump to FNNAME. If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
|
||
then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
|
||
to the stub instead. If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
|
||
stub should be discarded.
|
||
|
||
.mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
|
||
which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
|
||
to the gp regs. These stubs store the return value in $18 while
|
||
calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
|
||
must arrange to save $18 around the call. (This case is not
|
||
needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
|
||
16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
|
||
$f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
|
||
|
||
Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
|
||
Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally. Instead, the relocation
|
||
information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
|
||
|
||
We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table. */
|
||
|
||
#define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
|
||
#define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
|
||
#define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
|
||
|
||
/* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
|
||
|
||
#define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow) \
|
||
((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) \
|
||
elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create), \
|
||
(copy), (follow)))
|
||
|
||
/* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
|
||
|
||
#define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \
|
||
(elf_link_hash_traverse \
|
||
(&(table)->root, \
|
||
(bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \
|
||
(info)))
|
||
|
||
/* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
|
||
|
||
#define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
|
||
((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash))
|
||
|
||
/* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
|
||
|
||
static struct bfd_hash_entry *
|
||
mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
|
||
struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
|
||
(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
|
||
|
||
/* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
|
||
subclass. */
|
||
if (ret == NULL)
|
||
ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
|
||
if (ret == NULL)
|
||
return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
|
||
|
||
/* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
|
||
ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
|
||
_bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
|
||
table, string));
|
||
if (ret != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Set local fields. */
|
||
memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
|
||
/* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
|
||
not been set. -1 means there is no associated ifd. */
|
||
ret->esym.ifd = -2;
|
||
ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
|
||
ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
|
||
ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
|
||
ret->fn_stub = NULL;
|
||
ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
|
||
ret->call_stub = NULL;
|
||
ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
|
||
ret->forced_local = FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
|
||
{
|
||
struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
|
||
bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
|
||
|
||
sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (sdata == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
|
||
|
||
return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
|
||
ecoff_debug_info structure. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
|
||
struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
|
||
{
|
||
HDRR *symhdr;
|
||
const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
|
||
char *ext_hdr;
|
||
|
||
swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
|
||
memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
|
||
|
||
ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
|
||
if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
|
||
swap->external_hdr_size))
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
|
||
(*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
|
||
|
||
/* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
|
||
read. */
|
||
#define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type) \
|
||
if (symhdr->count == 0) \
|
||
debug->ptr = NULL; \
|
||
else \
|
||
{ \
|
||
bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count; \
|
||
debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt); \
|
||
if (debug->ptr == NULL) \
|
||
goto error_return; \
|
||
if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0 \
|
||
|| bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt) \
|
||
goto error_return; \
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
|
||
READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
|
||
READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
|
||
READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
|
||
READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
|
||
READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
|
||
union aux_ext *);
|
||
READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
|
||
READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
|
||
READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
|
||
READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
|
||
READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
|
||
#undef READ
|
||
|
||
debug->fdr = NULL;
|
||
debug->adjust = NULL;
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
error_return:
|
||
if (ext_hdr != NULL)
|
||
free (ext_hdr);
|
||
if (debug->line != NULL)
|
||
free (debug->line);
|
||
if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
|
||
free (debug->external_dnr);
|
||
if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
|
||
free (debug->external_pdr);
|
||
if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
|
||
free (debug->external_sym);
|
||
if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
|
||
free (debug->external_opt);
|
||
if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
|
||
free (debug->external_aux);
|
||
if (debug->ss != NULL)
|
||
free (debug->ss);
|
||
if (debug->ssext != NULL)
|
||
free (debug->ssext);
|
||
if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
|
||
free (debug->external_fdr);
|
||
if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
|
||
free (debug->external_rfd);
|
||
if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
|
||
free (debug->external_ext);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
|
||
{
|
||
H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
|
||
|
||
H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
|
||
H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
|
||
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
|
||
#if 0 /* FIXME */
|
||
H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->exception_info, ex->p_exception_info);
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
|
||
struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
|
||
{
|
||
const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
|
||
HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
|
||
RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
|
||
struct rpdr_ext *erp;
|
||
void *rtproc;
|
||
struct pdr_ext *epdr;
|
||
struct sym_ext *esym;
|
||
char *ss, **sv;
|
||
char *str;
|
||
bfd_size_type size;
|
||
bfd_size_type count;
|
||
unsigned long sindex;
|
||
unsigned long i;
|
||
PDR pdr;
|
||
SYMR sym;
|
||
const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
|
||
|
||
epdr = NULL;
|
||
rpdr = NULL;
|
||
esym = NULL;
|
||
ss = NULL;
|
||
sv = NULL;
|
||
|
||
swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
|
||
|
||
sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
|
||
count = hdr->ipdMax;
|
||
if (count > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
size = swap->external_pdr_size;
|
||
|
||
epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
|
||
if (epdr == NULL)
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
size = sizeof (RPDR);
|
||
rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
|
||
if (rpdr == NULL)
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
size = sizeof (char *);
|
||
sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
|
||
if (sv == NULL)
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
count = hdr->isymMax;
|
||
size = swap->external_sym_size;
|
||
esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
|
||
if (esym == NULL)
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
count = hdr->issMax;
|
||
ss = bfd_malloc (count);
|
||
if (ss == NULL)
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, ss))
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
count = hdr->ipdMax;
|
||
for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
|
||
{
|
||
(*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
|
||
(*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
|
||
rp->adr = sym.value;
|
||
rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
|
||
rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
|
||
rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
|
||
rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
|
||
rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
|
||
rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
|
||
rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
|
||
rp->irpss = sindex;
|
||
sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
|
||
sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
|
||
size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
|
||
rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
|
||
if (rtproc == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
|
||
|
||
erp = rtproc;
|
||
memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
|
||
erp++;
|
||
str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
|
||
strcpy (str, no_name_func);
|
||
str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
|
||
for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
|
||
strcpy (str, sv[i]);
|
||
str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
|
||
}
|
||
H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
|
||
|
||
/* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section. */
|
||
s->_raw_size = size;
|
||
s->contents = rtproc;
|
||
|
||
/* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
|
||
matters, but someday it might). */
|
||
s->link_order_head = NULL;
|
||
|
||
if (epdr != NULL)
|
||
free (epdr);
|
||
if (rpdr != NULL)
|
||
free (rpdr);
|
||
if (esym != NULL)
|
||
free (esym);
|
||
if (ss != NULL)
|
||
free (ss);
|
||
if (sv != NULL)
|
||
free (sv);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
error_return:
|
||
if (epdr != NULL)
|
||
free (epdr);
|
||
if (rpdr != NULL)
|
||
free (rpdr);
|
||
if (esym != NULL)
|
||
free (esym);
|
||
if (ss != NULL)
|
||
free (ss);
|
||
if (sv != NULL)
|
||
free (sv);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
|
||
discard them. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
|
||
void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
||
h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
|
||
|
||
if (h->fn_stub != NULL
|
||
&& ! h->need_fn_stub)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
|
||
are 16 bit calls. Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
|
||
being included in the link. */
|
||
h->fn_stub->_raw_size = 0;
|
||
h->fn_stub->_cooked_size = 0;
|
||
h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
|
||
h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
|
||
h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (h->call_stub != NULL
|
||
&& h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
|
||
calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
|
||
to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
|
||
h->call_stub->_raw_size = 0;
|
||
h->call_stub->_cooked_size = 0;
|
||
h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
|
||
h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
|
||
h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
|
||
&& h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
|
||
calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
|
||
to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
|
||
h->call_fp_stub->_raw_size = 0;
|
||
h->call_fp_stub->_cooked_size = 0;
|
||
h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
|
||
h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
|
||
h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
bfd_reloc_status_type
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
|
||
arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
|
||
bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_vma relocation;
|
||
bfd_signed_vma val;
|
||
bfd_reloc_status_type status;
|
||
|
||
if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
|
||
relocation = 0;
|
||
else
|
||
relocation = symbol->value;
|
||
|
||
relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
|
||
relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
|
||
|
||
if (reloc_entry->address > input_section->_cooked_size)
|
||
return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
|
||
|
||
/* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol. */
|
||
val = reloc_entry->addend;
|
||
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
|
||
|
||
/* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value. If we
|
||
are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
|
||
an external symbol. */
|
||
if (! relocatable
|
||
|| (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
|
||
val += relocation - gp;
|
||
|
||
if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
|
||
{
|
||
status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
|
||
(bfd_byte *) data
|
||
+ reloc_entry->address);
|
||
if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
|
||
return status;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
reloc_entry->addend = val;
|
||
|
||
if (relocatable)
|
||
reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
|
||
|
||
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
|
||
R_MIPS_GOT16. REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
|
||
that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
|
||
INPUT_SECTION. */
|
||
|
||
struct mips_hi16
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_hi16 *next;
|
||
bfd_byte *data;
|
||
asection *input_section;
|
||
arelent rel;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* FIXME: This should not be a static variable. */
|
||
|
||
static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
|
||
|
||
/* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations. We can only
|
||
calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
|
||
*LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
|
||
|
||
The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
|
||
However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
|
||
*HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16. This significantly
|
||
simplies the relocation handling in gcc. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_reloc_status_type
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
|
||
asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
|
||
asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
|
||
char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_hi16 *n;
|
||
|
||
if (reloc_entry->address > input_section->_cooked_size)
|
||
return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
|
||
|
||
n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
|
||
if (n == NULL)
|
||
return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
|
||
|
||
n->next = mips_hi16_list;
|
||
n->data = data;
|
||
n->input_section = input_section;
|
||
n->rel = *reloc_entry;
|
||
mips_hi16_list = n;
|
||
|
||
if (output_bfd != NULL)
|
||
reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
|
||
|
||
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations. This is just
|
||
like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
|
||
treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_reloc_status_type
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
|
||
void *data, asection *input_section,
|
||
bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
|
||
{
|
||
if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
|
||
|| bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
|
||
|| bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
|
||
/* The relocation is against a global symbol. */
|
||
return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
|
||
input_section, output_bfd,
|
||
error_message);
|
||
|
||
return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
|
||
input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations. The *LO16 itself
|
||
is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
|
||
any partnering high-part relocations as well. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_reloc_status_type
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
|
||
void *data, asection *input_section,
|
||
bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_vma vallo;
|
||
|
||
if (reloc_entry->address > input_section->_cooked_size)
|
||
return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
|
||
|
||
vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address);
|
||
while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
|
||
struct mips_hi16 *hi;
|
||
|
||
hi = mips_hi16_list;
|
||
|
||
/* R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case. We
|
||
want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS_HI16
|
||
relocation (with a rightshift of 16). However, since GOT16
|
||
relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
|
||
has a rightshift of 0. */
|
||
if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
|
||
hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
|
||
|
||
/* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number. Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
|
||
carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part. */
|
||
hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
|
||
|
||
/* R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16 relocations are relative to the address of the
|
||
lo16 relocation, not their own address. If we're calculating the
|
||
final value, and hence subtracting the "PC", subtract the offset
|
||
of the lo16 relocation from here. */
|
||
if (output_bfd == NULL && hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16)
|
||
hi->rel.addend -= reloc_entry->address - hi->rel.address;
|
||
|
||
ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
|
||
hi->input_section, output_bfd,
|
||
error_message);
|
||
if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
|
||
return ret;
|
||
|
||
mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
|
||
free (hi);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
|
||
input_section, output_bfd,
|
||
error_message);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A generic howto special_function. This calculates and installs the
|
||
relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
|
||
bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_reloc_status_type
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
|
||
asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
||
asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
|
||
char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_signed_vma val;
|
||
bfd_reloc_status_type status;
|
||
bfd_boolean relocatable;
|
||
|
||
relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
|
||
|
||
if (reloc_entry->address > input_section->_cooked_size)
|
||
return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
|
||
|
||
/* Build up the field adjustment in VAL. */
|
||
val = 0;
|
||
if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
|
||
relocation against a section symbol. Add in the section's
|
||
offset or address. */
|
||
val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
|
||
val += symbol->section->output_offset;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (!relocatable)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We're calculating the final field value. Add in the symbol's value
|
||
and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself. */
|
||
val += symbol->value;
|
||
if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
|
||
{
|
||
val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
|
||
val -= input_section->output_offset;
|
||
val -= reloc_entry->address;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* VAL is now the final adjustment. If we're keeping this relocation
|
||
in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
|
||
we just need to add VAL to that addend. Otherwise we need to add
|
||
VAL to the relocation field itself. */
|
||
if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
|
||
reloc_entry->addend += val;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Add in the separate addend, if any. */
|
||
val += reloc_entry->addend;
|
||
|
||
/* Add VAL to the relocation field. */
|
||
status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
|
||
(bfd_byte *) data
|
||
+ reloc_entry->address);
|
||
if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
|
||
return status;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (relocatable)
|
||
reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
|
||
|
||
return bfd_reloc_ok;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Swap an entry in a .gptab section. Note that these routines rely
|
||
on the equivalence of the two elements of the union. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
|
||
Elf32_gptab *in)
|
||
{
|
||
in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
|
||
in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
|
||
Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
|
||
{
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
|
||
Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
|
||
{
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
|
||
Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long l;
|
||
|
||
l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
|
||
| ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
|
||
| ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
|
||
| ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure. These
|
||
routines swap this structure in and out. They are used outside of
|
||
BFD, so they are globally visible. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
|
||
Elf32_RegInfo *in)
|
||
{
|
||
in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
|
||
in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
|
||
in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
|
||
in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
|
||
in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
|
||
in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
|
||
Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
|
||
{
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
|
||
information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure. These routines swap
|
||
them in and out. They are globally visible because they are used
|
||
outside of BFD. These routines are here so that gas can call them
|
||
without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
|
||
Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
|
||
{
|
||
in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
|
||
in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
|
||
in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
|
||
in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
|
||
in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
|
||
in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
|
||
in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
|
||
Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
|
||
{
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
|
||
H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Swap in an options header. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
|
||
Elf_Internal_Options *in)
|
||
{
|
||
in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
|
||
in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
|
||
in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
|
||
in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Swap out an options header. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
|
||
Elf_External_Options *ex)
|
||
{
|
||
H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
|
||
H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
|
||
H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
|
||
entries by increasing r_symndx value. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
|
||
Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
|
||
|
||
bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
|
||
bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
|
||
|
||
return ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
|
||
Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
|
||
|
||
(*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
|
||
(reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
|
||
(*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
|
||
(reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
|
||
|
||
return (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info)
|
||
- ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
|
||
information. It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse. The
|
||
ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
|
||
symbol information. Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
|
||
whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
|
||
tables may wind up being different. We must sort out the external
|
||
symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
|
||
section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
|
||
can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
|
||
required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
|
||
Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
|
||
stripped but required by a reloc. In particular, it can not happen
|
||
when generating a final executable. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
|
||
{
|
||
struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
|
||
bfd_boolean strip;
|
||
asection *sec, *output_section;
|
||
|
||
if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
||
h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
|
||
|
||
if (h->root.indx == -2)
|
||
strip = FALSE;
|
||
else if (((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0
|
||
|| (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_REF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
|
||
&& (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0
|
||
&& (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_REF_REGULAR) == 0)
|
||
strip = TRUE;
|
||
else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
|
||
|| (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
|
||
&& bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
|
||
h->root.root.root.string,
|
||
FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
|
||
strip = TRUE;
|
||
else
|
||
strip = FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (strip)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
|
||
{
|
||
h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
|
||
h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
|
||
h->esym.weakext = 0;
|
||
h->esym.reserved = 0;
|
||
h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
|
||
h->esym.asym.value = 0;
|
||
h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
|
||
|
||
if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
|
||
|| h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
|
||
{
|
||
const char *name;
|
||
|
||
/* Use undefined class. Also, set class and type for some
|
||
special symbols. */
|
||
name = h->root.root.root.string;
|
||
if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
|
||
h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
|
||
h->esym.asym.value = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
|
||
h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
|
||
h->esym.asym.value =
|
||
mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd))
|
||
{
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
|
||
h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
|
||
h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
|
||
&& h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
const char *name;
|
||
|
||
sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
|
||
output_section = sec->output_section;
|
||
|
||
/* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
|
||
the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null. */
|
||
if (output_section == NULL)
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
|
||
|
||
if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
|
||
else
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
|
||
h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
|
||
h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
|
||
else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
|
||
|| h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
|
||
{
|
||
if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
|
||
else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
|
||
h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
|
||
|
||
sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
|
||
output_section = sec->output_section;
|
||
if (output_section != NULL)
|
||
h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
|
||
+ sec->output_offset
|
||
+ output_section->vma);
|
||
else
|
||
h->esym.asym.value = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
else if ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
|
||
bfd_boolean no_fn_stub = h->no_fn_stub;
|
||
|
||
while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
|
||
{
|
||
hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
|
||
no_fn_stub = no_fn_stub || hd->no_fn_stub;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (!no_fn_stub)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub. */
|
||
h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
|
||
sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
|
||
if (sec == NULL)
|
||
h->esym.asym.value = 0;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
output_section = sec->output_section;
|
||
if (output_section != NULL)
|
||
h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.offset
|
||
+ sec->output_offset
|
||
+ output_section->vma);
|
||
else
|
||
h->esym.asym.value = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
#if 0 /* FIXME? */
|
||
h->esym.ifd = 0;
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
|
||
h->root.root.root.string,
|
||
&h->esym))
|
||
{
|
||
einfo->failed = TRUE;
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
|
||
{
|
||
const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
|
||
const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
|
||
|
||
return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Functions to manage the got entry hash table. */
|
||
|
||
/* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
|
||
hash number. */
|
||
|
||
static INLINE hashval_t
|
||
mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
|
||
{
|
||
#ifdef BFD64
|
||
return addr + (addr >> 32);
|
||
#else
|
||
return addr;
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* got_entries only match if they're identical, except for gotidx, so
|
||
use all fields to compute the hash, and compare the appropriate
|
||
union members. */
|
||
|
||
static hashval_t
|
||
mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
|
||
{
|
||
const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
|
||
|
||
return entry->symndx
|
||
+ (! entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
|
||
: entry->abfd->id
|
||
+ (entry->symndx >= 0 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)
|
||
: entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
|
||
{
|
||
const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
|
||
const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
|
||
|
||
return e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->symndx == e2->symndx
|
||
&& (! e1->abfd ? e1->d.address == e2->d.address
|
||
: e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
|
||
: e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* multi_got_entries are still a match in the case of global objects,
|
||
even if the input bfd in which they're referenced differs, so the
|
||
hash computation and compare functions are adjusted
|
||
accordingly. */
|
||
|
||
static hashval_t
|
||
mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
|
||
{
|
||
const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
|
||
|
||
return entry->symndx
|
||
+ (! entry->abfd
|
||
? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
|
||
: entry->symndx >= 0
|
||
? (entry->abfd->id
|
||
+ mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend))
|
||
: entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
|
||
{
|
||
const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
|
||
const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
|
||
|
||
return e1->symndx == e2->symndx
|
||
&& (e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
|
||
: e1->abfd == NULL || e2->abfd == NULL
|
||
? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
|
||
: e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns the dynamic relocation section for DYNOBJ. */
|
||
|
||
static asection *
|
||
mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (bfd *dynobj, bfd_boolean create_p)
|
||
{
|
||
static const char dname[] = ".rel.dyn";
|
||
asection *sreloc;
|
||
|
||
sreloc = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, dname);
|
||
if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
|
||
{
|
||
sreloc = bfd_make_section (dynobj, dname);
|
||
if (sreloc == NULL
|
||
|| ! bfd_set_section_flags (dynobj, sreloc,
|
||
(SEC_ALLOC
|
||
| SEC_LOAD
|
||
| SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
|
||
| SEC_IN_MEMORY
|
||
| SEC_LINKER_CREATED
|
||
| SEC_READONLY))
|
||
|| ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
|
||
MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
return sreloc;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns the GOT section for ABFD. */
|
||
|
||
static asection *
|
||
mips_elf_got_section (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *sgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
|
||
if (sgot == NULL
|
||
|| (! maybe_excluded && (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0))
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
return sgot;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns the GOT information associated with the link indicated by
|
||
INFO. If SGOTP is non-NULL, it is filled in with the GOT
|
||
section. */
|
||
|
||
static struct mips_got_info *
|
||
mips_elf_got_info (bfd *abfd, asection **sgotp)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *sgot;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
|
||
sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
|
||
g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
|
||
|
||
if (sgotp)
|
||
*sgotp = (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0 ? sgot : NULL;
|
||
|
||
return g;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Obtain the lowest dynamic index of a symbol that was assigned a
|
||
global GOT entry. */
|
||
static long
|
||
mips_elf_get_global_gotsym_index (bfd *abfd)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *sgot;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
|
||
if (abfd == NULL)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
|
||
if (sgot == NULL || mips_elf_section_data (sgot) == NULL)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
|
||
if (g == NULL || g->global_gotsym == NULL)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
return g->global_gotsym->dynindx;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns the GOT offset at which the indicated address can be found.
|
||
If there is not yet a GOT entry for this value, create one. Returns
|
||
-1 if no satisfactory GOT offset can be found. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_vma
|
||
mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
bfd_vma value)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *sgot;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
struct mips_got_entry *entry;
|
||
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
|
||
|
||
entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot, value);
|
||
if (entry)
|
||
return entry->gotidx;
|
||
else
|
||
return MINUS_ONE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_vma
|
||
mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_vma index;
|
||
asection *sgot;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
|
||
long global_got_dynindx = 0;
|
||
|
||
gg = g = mips_elf_got_info (abfd, &sgot);
|
||
if (g->bfd2got && ibfd)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= 0);
|
||
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
|
||
if (g->next != gg)
|
||
{
|
||
e.abfd = ibfd;
|
||
e.symndx = -1;
|
||
e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
|
||
|
||
p = htab_find (g->got_entries, &e);
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (p->gotidx > 0);
|
||
return p->gotidx;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (gg->global_gotsym != NULL)
|
||
global_got_dynindx = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
|
||
|
||
/* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
|
||
symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
|
||
indices into the GOT. That makes it easy to calculate the GOT
|
||
offset. */
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
|
||
index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
|
||
* MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (index < sgot->_raw_size);
|
||
|
||
return index;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Find a GOT entry that is within 32KB of the VALUE. These entries
|
||
are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
|
||
within 32KB of GP. Return the index into the GOT for this page,
|
||
and store the offset from this entry to the desired address in
|
||
OFFSETP, if it is non-NULL. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_vma
|
||
mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *sgot;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
bfd_vma index;
|
||
struct mips_got_entry *entry;
|
||
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
|
||
|
||
entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot,
|
||
(value + 0x8000)
|
||
& (~(bfd_vma)0xffff));
|
||
|
||
if (!entry)
|
||
return MINUS_ONE;
|
||
|
||
index = entry->gotidx;
|
||
|
||
if (offsetp)
|
||
*offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
|
||
|
||
return index;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Find a GOT entry whose higher-order 16 bits are the same as those
|
||
for value. Return the index into the GOT for this entry. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_vma
|
||
mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *sgot;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
struct mips_got_entry *entry;
|
||
|
||
if (! external)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Although the ABI says that it is "the high-order 16 bits" that we
|
||
want, it is really the %high value. The complete value is
|
||
calculated with a `addiu' of a LO16 relocation, just as with a
|
||
HI16/LO16 pair. */
|
||
value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
|
||
|
||
entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot, value);
|
||
if (entry)
|
||
return entry->gotidx;
|
||
else
|
||
return MINUS_ONE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
|
||
in the GOT. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_vma
|
||
mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (bfd *dynobj, bfd *output_bfd,
|
||
bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma index)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *sgot;
|
||
bfd_vma gp;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
|
||
gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
|
||
+ mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, g, input_bfd);
|
||
|
||
return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + index - gp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Create a local GOT entry for VALUE. Return the index of the entry,
|
||
or -1 if it could not be created. */
|
||
|
||
static struct mips_got_entry *
|
||
mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd,
|
||
struct mips_got_info *gg,
|
||
asection *sgot, bfd_vma value)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
|
||
entry.abfd = NULL;
|
||
entry.symndx = -1;
|
||
entry.d.address = value;
|
||
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, ibfd);
|
||
if (g == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, abfd);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
|
||
INSERT);
|
||
if (*loc)
|
||
return *loc;
|
||
|
||
entry.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_gotno++;
|
||
|
||
*loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
|
||
|
||
if (! *loc)
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
|
||
memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
|
||
|
||
if (g->assigned_gotno >= g->local_gotno)
|
||
{
|
||
(*loc)->gotidx = -1;
|
||
/* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT. */
|
||
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
||
(_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
|
||
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value,
|
||
(sgot->contents + entry.gotidx));
|
||
|
||
return *loc;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
|
||
appear towards the end. This reduces the amount of GOT space
|
||
required. MAX_LOCAL is used to set the number of local symbols
|
||
known to be in the dynamic symbol table. During
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections, this value is 1. Afterward, the
|
||
section symbols are added and the count is higher. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_sort_hash_table (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned long max_local)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
bfd *dynobj;
|
||
|
||
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
||
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
|
||
|
||
hsd.low = NULL;
|
||
hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx =
|
||
hsd.min_got_dynindx = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
|
||
/* In the multi-got case, assigned_gotno of the master got_info
|
||
indicate the number of entries that aren't referenced in the
|
||
primary GOT, but that must have entries because there are
|
||
dynamic relocations that reference it. Since they aren't
|
||
referenced, we move them to the end of the GOT, so that they
|
||
don't prevent other entries that are referenced from getting
|
||
too large offsets. */
|
||
- (g->next ? g->assigned_gotno : 0);
|
||
hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = max_local;
|
||
mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *)
|
||
elf_hash_table (info)),
|
||
mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f,
|
||
&hsd);
|
||
|
||
/* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
|
||
accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols. */
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned long)hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
|
||
<= elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount);
|
||
|
||
/* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
|
||
table index in the GOT. */
|
||
g->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
|
||
index. Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
|
||
index. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
|
||
|
||
if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
||
h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
|
||
|
||
/* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
|
||
at all. */
|
||
if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
/* Global symbols that need GOT entries that are not explicitly
|
||
referenced are marked with got offset 2. Those that are
|
||
referenced get a 1, and those that don't need GOT entries get
|
||
-1. */
|
||
if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
|
||
{
|
||
if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
|
||
hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
||
h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (h->root.got.offset != 1)
|
||
h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
|
||
hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If H is a symbol that needs a global GOT entry, but has a dynamic
|
||
symbol table index lower than any we've seen to date, record it for
|
||
posterity. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
|
||
bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
|
||
|
||
/* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
|
||
table. */
|
||
if (h->dynindx == -1)
|
||
{
|
||
switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
|
||
{
|
||
case STV_INTERNAL:
|
||
case STV_HIDDEN:
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
entry.abfd = abfd;
|
||
entry.symndx = -1;
|
||
entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
||
|
||
loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
|
||
INSERT);
|
||
|
||
/* If we've already marked this entry as needing GOT space, we don't
|
||
need to do it again. */
|
||
if (*loc)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
*loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
|
||
|
||
if (! *loc)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
entry.gotidx = -1;
|
||
memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
|
||
|
||
if (h->got.offset != MINUS_ONE)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
/* By setting this to a value other than -1, we are indicating that
|
||
there needs to be a GOT entry for H. Avoid using zero, as the
|
||
generic ELF copy_indirect_symbol tests for <= 0. */
|
||
h->got.offset = 1;
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Reserve space in G for a GOT entry containing the value of symbol
|
||
SYMNDX in input bfd ABDF, plus ADDEND. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
|
||
|
||
entry.abfd = abfd;
|
||
entry.symndx = symndx;
|
||
entry.d.addend = addend;
|
||
loc = (struct mips_got_entry **)
|
||
htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, INSERT);
|
||
|
||
if (*loc)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
entry.gotidx = g->local_gotno++;
|
||
|
||
*loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
|
||
|
||
if (! *loc)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Compute the hash value of the bfd in a bfd2got hash entry. */
|
||
|
||
static hashval_t
|
||
mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
|
||
{
|
||
const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *entry
|
||
= (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry_;
|
||
|
||
return entry->bfd->id;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Check whether two hash entries have the same bfd. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
|
||
{
|
||
const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e1
|
||
= (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry1;
|
||
const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e2
|
||
= (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry2;
|
||
|
||
return e1->bfd == e2->bfd;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* In a multi-got link, determine the GOT to be used for IBDF. G must
|
||
be the master GOT data. */
|
||
|
||
static struct mips_got_info *
|
||
mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash e, *p;
|
||
|
||
if (! g->bfd2got)
|
||
return g;
|
||
|
||
e.bfd = ibfd;
|
||
p = htab_find (g->bfd2got, &e);
|
||
return p ? p->g : NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Create one separate got for each bfd that has entries in the global
|
||
got, such that we can tell how many local and global entries each
|
||
bfd requires. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
|
||
struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
|
||
htab_t bfd2got = arg->bfd2got;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash bfdgot_entry, *bfdgot;
|
||
void **bfdgotp;
|
||
|
||
/* Find the got_info for this GOT entry's input bfd. Create one if
|
||
none exists. */
|
||
bfdgot_entry.bfd = entry->abfd;
|
||
bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (bfd2got, &bfdgot_entry, INSERT);
|
||
bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfdgotp;
|
||
|
||
if (bfdgot != NULL)
|
||
g = bfdgot->g;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
|
||
(arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
|
||
|
||
if (bfdgot == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
arg->obfd = 0;
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
*bfdgotp = bfdgot;
|
||
|
||
bfdgot->bfd = entry->abfd;
|
||
bfdgot->g = g = (struct mips_got_info *)
|
||
bfd_alloc (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
|
||
if (g == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
arg->obfd = 0;
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
g->global_gotsym = NULL;
|
||
g->global_gotno = 0;
|
||
g->local_gotno = 0;
|
||
g->assigned_gotno = -1;
|
||
g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
|
||
mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, NULL);
|
||
if (g->got_entries == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
arg->obfd = 0;
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
g->bfd2got = NULL;
|
||
g->next = NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */
|
||
entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
|
||
if (*entryp != NULL)
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
*entryp = entry;
|
||
|
||
if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->forced_local)
|
||
++g->local_gotno;
|
||
else
|
||
++g->global_gotno;
|
||
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Attempt to merge gots of different input bfds. Try to use as much
|
||
as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
|
||
dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
|
||
symbols out of the addressable range. Failing the primary got,
|
||
attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
|
||
and then make make the new got current. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
mips_elf_merge_gots (void **bfd2got_, void *p)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got
|
||
= (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfd2got_;
|
||
struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
|
||
unsigned int lcount = bfd2got->g->local_gotno;
|
||
unsigned int gcount = bfd2got->g->global_gotno;
|
||
unsigned int maxcnt = arg->max_count;
|
||
|
||
/* If we don't have a primary GOT and this is not too big, use it as
|
||
a starting point for the primary GOT. */
|
||
if (! arg->primary && lcount + gcount <= maxcnt)
|
||
{
|
||
arg->primary = bfd2got->g;
|
||
arg->primary_count = lcount + gcount;
|
||
}
|
||
/* If it looks like we can merge this bfd's entries with those of
|
||
the primary, merge them. The heuristics is conservative, but we
|
||
don't have to squeeze it too hard. */
|
||
else if (arg->primary
|
||
&& (arg->primary_count + lcount + gcount) <= maxcnt)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
|
||
int old_lcount = arg->primary->local_gotno;
|
||
int old_gcount = arg->primary->global_gotno;
|
||
|
||
bfd2got->g = arg->primary;
|
||
|
||
htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
|
||
mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
|
||
arg);
|
||
if (arg->obfd == NULL)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
htab_delete (g->got_entries);
|
||
/* We don't have to worry about releasing memory of the actual
|
||
got entries, since they're all in the master got_entries hash
|
||
table anyway. */
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->primary->local_gotno);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->primary->global_gotno);
|
||
|
||
arg->primary_count = arg->primary->local_gotno
|
||
+ arg->primary->global_gotno;
|
||
}
|
||
/* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it. */
|
||
else if (arg->current
|
||
&& arg->current_count + lcount + gcount <= maxcnt)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
|
||
int old_lcount = arg->current->local_gotno;
|
||
int old_gcount = arg->current->global_gotno;
|
||
|
||
bfd2got->g = arg->current;
|
||
|
||
htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
|
||
mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
|
||
arg);
|
||
if (arg->obfd == NULL)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
htab_delete (g->got_entries);
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->current->local_gotno);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->current->global_gotno);
|
||
|
||
arg->current_count = arg->current->local_gotno
|
||
+ arg->current->global_gotno;
|
||
}
|
||
/* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT. Don't check if it
|
||
fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
|
||
overflows anyway. */
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
bfd2got->g->next = arg->current;
|
||
arg->current = bfd2got->g;
|
||
|
||
arg->current_count = lcount + gcount;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If passed a NULL mips_got_info in the argument, set the marker used
|
||
to tell whether a global symbol needs a got entry (in the primary
|
||
got) to the given VALUE.
|
||
|
||
If passed a pointer G to a mips_got_info in the argument (it must
|
||
not be the primary GOT), compute the offset from the beginning of
|
||
the (primary) GOT section to the entry in G corresponding to the
|
||
global symbol. G's assigned_gotno must contain the index of the
|
||
first available global GOT entry in G. VALUE must contain the size
|
||
of a GOT entry in bytes. For each global GOT entry that requires a
|
||
dynamic relocation, NEEDED_RELOCS is incremented, and the symbol is
|
||
marked as not eligible for lazy resolution through a function
|
||
stub. */
|
||
static int
|
||
mips_elf_set_global_got_offset (void **entryp, void *p)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
|
||
struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *arg
|
||
= (struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *)p;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
|
||
|
||
if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1
|
||
&& entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1)
|
||
{
|
||
if (g)
|
||
{
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotsym == NULL);
|
||
|
||
entry->gotidx = arg->value * (long) g->assigned_gotno++;
|
||
if (arg->info->shared
|
||
|| (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
|
||
&& ((entry->d.h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
|
||
&& ((entry->d.h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)))
|
||
++arg->needed_relocs;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
entry->d.h->root.got.offset = arg->value;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Mark any global symbols referenced in the GOT we are iterating over
|
||
as inelligible for lazy resolution stubs. */
|
||
static int
|
||
mips_elf_set_no_stub (void **entryp, void *p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
|
||
|
||
if (entry->abfd != NULL
|
||
&& entry->symndx == -1
|
||
&& entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1)
|
||
entry->d.h->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
|
||
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Follow indirect and warning hash entries so that each got entry
|
||
points to the final symbol definition. P must point to a pointer
|
||
to the hash table we're traversing. Since this traversal may
|
||
modify the hash table, we set this pointer to NULL to indicate
|
||
we've made a potentially-destructive change to the hash table, so
|
||
the traversal must be restarted. */
|
||
static int
|
||
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry (void **entryp, void *p)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
|
||
htab_t got_entries = *(htab_t *)p;
|
||
|
||
if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = entry->d.h;
|
||
|
||
while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
|
||
|| h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
||
h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
|
||
|
||
if (entry->d.h == h)
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
entry->d.h = h;
|
||
|
||
/* If we can't find this entry with the new bfd hash, re-insert
|
||
it, and get the traversal restarted. */
|
||
if (! htab_find (got_entries, entry))
|
||
{
|
||
htab_clear_slot (got_entries, entryp);
|
||
entryp = htab_find_slot (got_entries, entry, INSERT);
|
||
if (! *entryp)
|
||
*entryp = entry;
|
||
/* Abort the traversal, since the whole table may have
|
||
moved, and leave it up to the parent to restart the
|
||
process. */
|
||
*(htab_t *)p = NULL;
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
/* We might want to decrement the global_gotno count, but it's
|
||
either too early or too late for that at this point. */
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Turn indirect got entries in a got_entries table into their final
|
||
locations. */
|
||
static void
|
||
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct mips_got_info *g)
|
||
{
|
||
htab_t got_entries;
|
||
|
||
do
|
||
{
|
||
got_entries = g->got_entries;
|
||
|
||
htab_traverse (got_entries,
|
||
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry,
|
||
&got_entries);
|
||
}
|
||
while (got_entries == NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
|
||
the primary GOT. */
|
||
static bfd_vma
|
||
mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
|
||
{
|
||
if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
|
||
if (! g)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
|
||
|
||
g = g->next;
|
||
|
||
return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
|
||
a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g, asection *got,
|
||
bfd_size_type pages)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
|
||
struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *gg;
|
||
unsigned int assign;
|
||
|
||
g->bfd2got = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash,
|
||
mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq, NULL);
|
||
if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
got_per_bfd_arg.bfd2got = g->bfd2got;
|
||
got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
|
||
got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
|
||
|
||
/* Count how many GOT entries each input bfd requires, creating a
|
||
map from bfd to got info while at that. */
|
||
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
|
||
htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, &got_per_bfd_arg);
|
||
if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
|
||
got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
|
||
/* Taking out PAGES entries is a worst-case estimate. We could
|
||
compute the maximum number of pages that each separate input bfd
|
||
uses, but it's probably not worth it. */
|
||
got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (abfd)
|
||
/ MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
|
||
- MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO - pages);
|
||
|
||
/* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
|
||
don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
|
||
to be the primary GOT. */
|
||
htab_traverse (g->bfd2got, mips_elf_merge_gots, &got_per_bfd_arg);
|
||
if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* If we find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one. */
|
||
if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
g->next = (struct mips_got_info *)
|
||
bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
|
||
if (g->next == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
g->next->global_gotsym = NULL;
|
||
g->next->global_gotno = 0;
|
||
g->next->local_gotno = 0;
|
||
g->next->assigned_gotno = 0;
|
||
g->next->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
|
||
mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq,
|
||
NULL);
|
||
if (g->next->got_entries == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
g->next->bfd2got = NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
|
||
g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
|
||
|
||
/* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT. */
|
||
gg = g;
|
||
g = g->next;
|
||
|
||
/* Map the output bfd to the primary got. That's what we're going
|
||
to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
|
||
didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
|
||
We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
|
||
list. */
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfdgot;
|
||
void **bfdgotp;
|
||
|
||
bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
|
||
(abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
|
||
|
||
if (bfdgot == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
bfdgot->bfd = abfd;
|
||
bfdgot->g = g;
|
||
bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (gg->bfd2got, bfdgot, INSERT);
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (*bfdgotp == NULL);
|
||
*bfdgotp = bfdgot;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The IRIX dynamic linker requires every symbol that is referenced
|
||
in a dynamic relocation to be present in the primary GOT, so
|
||
arrange for them to appear after those that are actually
|
||
referenced.
|
||
|
||
GNU/Linux could very well do without it, but it would slow down
|
||
the dynamic linker, since it would have to resolve every dynamic
|
||
symbol referenced in other GOTs more than once, without help from
|
||
the cache. Also, knowing that every external symbol has a GOT
|
||
helps speed up the resolution of local symbols too, so GNU/Linux
|
||
follows IRIX's practice.
|
||
|
||
The number 2 is used by mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f to count
|
||
global GOT symbols that are unreferenced in the primary GOT, with
|
||
an initial dynamic index computed from gg->assigned_gotno, where
|
||
the number of unreferenced global entries in the primary GOT is
|
||
preserved. */
|
||
if (1)
|
||
{
|
||
gg->assigned_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
|
||
g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
|
||
set_got_offset_arg.value = 2;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* This could be used for dynamic linkers that don't optimize
|
||
symbol resolution while applying relocations so as to use
|
||
primary GOT entries or assuming the symbol is locally-defined.
|
||
With this code, we assign lower dynamic indices to global
|
||
symbols that are not referenced in the primary GOT, so that
|
||
their entries can be omitted. */
|
||
gg->assigned_gotno = 0;
|
||
set_got_offset_arg.value = -1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Reorder dynamic symbols as described above (which behavior
|
||
depends on the setting of VALUE). */
|
||
set_got_offset_arg.g = NULL;
|
||
htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
|
||
&set_got_offset_arg);
|
||
set_got_offset_arg.value = 1;
|
||
htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
|
||
&set_got_offset_arg);
|
||
if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
|
||
[assigned_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
|
||
entries in each GOT. We can then compute the end of a GOT by
|
||
adding local_gotno to global_gotno. We reverse the list and make
|
||
it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
|
||
beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor. To
|
||
avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
|
||
assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
|
||
we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
|
||
global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
|
||
offset of the primary GOT is zero. Remember that the primary GOT
|
||
will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
|
||
points back to the master GOT. */
|
||
gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
|
||
gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
|
||
assign = 0;
|
||
gg->next = gg;
|
||
|
||
do
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_info *gn;
|
||
|
||
assign += MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
|
||
g->assigned_gotno = assign;
|
||
g->local_gotno += assign + pages;
|
||
assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
|
||
|
||
/* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
|
||
list that gg points to. */
|
||
gn = g->next;
|
||
g->next = gg->next;
|
||
gg->next = g;
|
||
g = gn;
|
||
|
||
/* Mark global symbols in every non-primary GOT as ineligible for
|
||
stubs. */
|
||
if (g)
|
||
htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_no_stub, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
while (g);
|
||
|
||
got->_raw_size = (gg->next->local_gotno
|
||
+ gg->next->global_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
|
||
RELOCATION. RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table. */
|
||
|
||
static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
|
||
mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
|
||
{
|
||
/* According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation must be
|
||
immediately following. However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next
|
||
relocation may be a composed relocation consisting of several
|
||
relocations for the same address. In that case, the R_MIPS_LO16
|
||
relocation may occur as one of these. We permit a similar
|
||
extension in general, as that is useful for GCC. */
|
||
while (relocation < relend)
|
||
{
|
||
if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type)
|
||
return relocation;
|
||
|
||
++relocation;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We didn't find it. */
|
||
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return whether a relocation is against a local symbol. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
|
||
asection **local_sections,
|
||
bfd_boolean check_forced)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long r_symndx;
|
||
Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
||
size_t extsymoff;
|
||
|
||
r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
|
||
symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
|
||
extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
|
||
|
||
if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
if (check_forced)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Look up the hash table to check whether the symbol
|
||
was forced local. */
|
||
h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
|
||
elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
|
||
/* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
|
||
while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
|
||
|| h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
||
h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
|
||
if ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_FORCED_LOCAL) != 0)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_vma
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
|
||
{
|
||
if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
|
||
/* VALUE is negative. */
|
||
value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
|
||
|
||
return value;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
|
||
range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
|
||
BITS. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
|
||
|
||
if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
|
||
/* The value is too big. */
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
|
||
/* The value is too small. */
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
/* All is well. */
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Calculate the %high function. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_vma
|
||
mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
|
||
{
|
||
return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Calculate the %higher function. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_vma
|
||
mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
#ifdef BFD64
|
||
return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
|
||
#else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
return (bfd_vma) -1;
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Calculate the %highest function. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_vma
|
||
mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
#ifdef BFD64
|
||
return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
|
||
#else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
return (bfd_vma) -1;
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Create the .compact_rel section. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
|
||
(bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
flagword flags;
|
||
register asection *s;
|
||
|
||
if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
|
||
| SEC_READONLY);
|
||
|
||
s = bfd_make_section (abfd, ".compact_rel");
|
||
if (s == NULL
|
||
|| ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags)
|
||
|| ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
|
||
MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
s->_raw_size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)
|
||
{
|
||
flagword flags;
|
||
register asection *s;
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
||
struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
bfd_size_type amt;
|
||
|
||
/* This function may be called more than once. */
|
||
s = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
|
||
if (s)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! maybe_exclude)
|
||
s->flags &= ~SEC_EXCLUDE;
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
|
||
| SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
|
||
|
||
if (maybe_exclude)
|
||
flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
|
||
|
||
/* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
|
||
in the function stub generation and in the linker script. */
|
||
s = bfd_make_section (abfd, ".got");
|
||
if (s == NULL
|
||
|| ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags)
|
||
|| ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. We don't do this in the
|
||
linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
|
||
are not creating a global offset table. */
|
||
bh = NULL;
|
||
if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
|
||
(info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
|
||
0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
|
||
h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF;
|
||
h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR;
|
||
h->type = STT_OBJECT;
|
||
|
||
if (info->shared
|
||
&& ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
amt = sizeof (struct mips_got_info);
|
||
g = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (g == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
g->global_gotsym = NULL;
|
||
g->global_gotno = 0;
|
||
g->local_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
|
||
g->assigned_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
|
||
g->bfd2got = NULL;
|
||
g->next = NULL;
|
||
g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
|
||
mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
|
||
if (g->got_entries == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
mips_elf_section_data (s)->u.got_info = g;
|
||
mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
|
||
|= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
|
||
the INPUT_BFD). The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
|
||
RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
|
||
|
||
The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
|
||
REQUIRE_JALXP indicates whether or not the opcode used with this
|
||
relocation must be JALX.
|
||
|
||
This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
|
||
further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
|
||
something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
|
||
overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_reloc_status_type
|
||
mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
|
||
asection *input_section,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
|
||
bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
|
||
Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
|
||
asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
|
||
const char **namep, bfd_boolean *require_jalxp,
|
||
bfd_boolean save_addend)
|
||
{
|
||
/* The eventual value we will return. */
|
||
bfd_vma value;
|
||
/* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
|
||
occurring. */
|
||
bfd_vma symbol = 0;
|
||
/* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
|
||
shared object file being produced. */
|
||
bfd_vma gp = MINUS_ONE;
|
||
/* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
|
||
relocated. */
|
||
bfd_vma p;
|
||
/* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object. */
|
||
bfd_vma gp0 = MINUS_ONE;
|
||
/* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
|
||
the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
|
||
during execution. */
|
||
bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
|
||
/* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
|
||
located. */
|
||
asection *sec = NULL;
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
|
||
/* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
|
||
symbol. */
|
||
bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
|
||
/* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp". */
|
||
bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
|
||
Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
|
||
size_t extsymoff;
|
||
unsigned long r_symndx;
|
||
int r_type;
|
||
/* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
|
||
relocation value. */
|
||
bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
|
||
/* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function. */
|
||
bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Parse the relocation. */
|
||
r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
|
||
r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
|
||
p = (input_section->output_section->vma
|
||
+ input_section->output_offset
|
||
+ relocation->r_offset);
|
||
|
||
/* Assume that there will be no overflow. */
|
||
overflowed_p = FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
|
||
used in the array of hash table entries. */
|
||
symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
|
||
local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
|
||
local_sections, FALSE);
|
||
was_local_p = local_p;
|
||
if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
|
||
extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
|
||
must come before globals. */
|
||
extsymoff = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Figure out the value of the symbol. */
|
||
if (local_p)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
|
||
|
||
sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
|
||
sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
|
||
|
||
symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
|
||
if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION
|
||
|| (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
|
||
symbol += sym->st_value;
|
||
if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
|
||
&& ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
|
||
{
|
||
addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
|
||
addend -= symbol;
|
||
addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* MIPS16 text labels should be treated as odd. */
|
||
if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
|
||
++symbol;
|
||
|
||
/* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
|
||
*namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
|
||
symtab_hdr->sh_link,
|
||
sym->st_name);
|
||
if (*namep == '\0')
|
||
*namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
|
||
|
||
target_is_16_bit_code_p = (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ? */
|
||
|
||
/* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table. */
|
||
h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
|
||
elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
|
||
/* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
|
||
while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
|
||
|| h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
||
h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
|
||
|
||
/* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
|
||
*namep = h->root.root.root.string;
|
||
|
||
/* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol. Note that such a
|
||
symbol must always be a global symbol. */
|
||
if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
|
||
&& ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
|
||
R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations. */
|
||
if (r_type != R_MIPS_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS_LO16)
|
||
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
||
|
||
gp_disp_p = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
/* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address. Note that
|
||
_gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
|
||
linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
|
||
its defined. */
|
||
else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
|
||
|| h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
|
||
&& h->root.root.u.def.section)
|
||
{
|
||
sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
|
||
if (sec->output_section)
|
||
symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
|
||
+ sec->output_section->vma
|
||
+ sec->output_offset);
|
||
else
|
||
symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
|
||
/* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
|
||
it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
|
||
and check to see if they exist by looking at their
|
||
addresses. */
|
||
symbol = 0;
|
||
else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
|
||
&& ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
|
||
symbol = 0;
|
||
else if (strcmp (*namep, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0 ||
|
||
strcmp (*namep, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
|
||
_DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
|
||
in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
|
||
Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
|
||
FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
|
||
somehow as well. */
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (! info->shared);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
|
||
symbol = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (! ((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
|
||
(info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
|
||
input_section, relocation->r_offset,
|
||
(info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
|
||
|| ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other))))
|
||
return bfd_reloc_undefined;
|
||
symbol = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
target_is_16_bit_code_p = (h->root.other == STO_MIPS16);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function with a stub, we
|
||
need to redirect the call to the stub, unless we're already *in*
|
||
a stub. */
|
||
if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
|
||
&& ((h != NULL && h->fn_stub != NULL)
|
||
|| (local_p && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
|
||
&& elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
|
||
&& !mips_elf_stub_section_p (input_bfd, input_section))
|
||
{
|
||
/* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function. We should
|
||
have already noticed that we were going to need the
|
||
stub. */
|
||
if (local_p)
|
||
sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
|
||
sec = h->fn_stub;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
|
||
}
|
||
/* If this is a 16-bit call to a 32- or 64-bit function with a stub, we
|
||
need to redirect the call to the stub. */
|
||
else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
|
||
&& h != NULL
|
||
&& (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
|
||
&& !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
|
||
out which one to use by seeing which one appears in the input
|
||
file. */
|
||
if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *o;
|
||
|
||
sec = NULL;
|
||
for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
|
||
{
|
||
if (strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o),
|
||
CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
sec = h->call_fp_stub;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
if (sec == NULL)
|
||
sec = h->call_stub;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
|
||
sec = h->call_stub;
|
||
else
|
||
sec = h->call_fp_stub;
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (sec->_raw_size > 0);
|
||
symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
|
||
special jalx instruction. */
|
||
*require_jalxp = (!info->relocatable
|
||
&& (((r_type == R_MIPS16_26) && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
|
||
|| ((r_type == R_MIPS_26) && target_is_16_bit_code_p)));
|
||
|
||
local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
|
||
local_sections, TRUE);
|
||
|
||
/* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, or the GP value,
|
||
and we're going to need it, get it now. */
|
||
switch (r_type)
|
||
{
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
|
||
/* We need to decay to GOT_DISP/addend if the symbol doesn't
|
||
bind locally. */
|
||
local_p = local_p || _bfd_elf_symbol_refs_local_p (&h->root, info, 1);
|
||
if (local_p || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_OFST)
|
||
break;
|
||
/* Fall through. */
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
|
||
/* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located. */
|
||
if (!local_p)
|
||
{
|
||
/* GOT_PAGE may take a non-zero addend, that is ignored in a
|
||
GOT_PAGE relocation that decays to GOT_DISP because the
|
||
symbol turns out to be global. The addend is then added
|
||
as GOT_OFST. */
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
|
||
g = mips_elf_global_got_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
|
||
input_bfd,
|
||
(struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h);
|
||
if (! elf_hash_table(info)->dynamic_sections_created
|
||
|| (info->shared
|
||
&& (info->symbolic || h->root.dynindx == -1)
|
||
&& (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* This is a static link or a -Bsymbolic link. The
|
||
symbol is defined locally, or was forced to be local.
|
||
We must initialize this entry in the GOT. */
|
||
bfd *tmpbfd = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
||
asection *sgot = mips_elf_got_section (tmpbfd, FALSE);
|
||
MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (tmpbfd, symbol, sgot->contents + g);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16)
|
||
/* There's no need to create a local GOT entry here; the
|
||
calculation for a local GOT16 entry does not involve G. */
|
||
break;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd,
|
||
info, symbol + addend);
|
||
if (g == MINUS_ONE)
|
||
return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets. */
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
|
||
abfd, input_bfd, g);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_HI16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_LO16:
|
||
case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
|
||
case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
|
||
gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
|
||
gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
|
||
if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj)
|
||
gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd,
|
||
mips_elf_got_info
|
||
(elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, NULL),
|
||
input_bfd);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed. */
|
||
switch (r_type)
|
||
{
|
||
case R_MIPS_NONE:
|
||
return bfd_reloc_continue;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_16:
|
||
value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
|
||
overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_32:
|
||
case R_MIPS_REL32:
|
||
case R_MIPS_64:
|
||
if ((info->shared
|
||
|| (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
|
||
&& h != NULL
|
||
&& ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
|
||
&& ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)))
|
||
&& r_symndx != 0
|
||
&& (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If we're creating a shared library, or this relocation is
|
||
against a symbol in a shared library, then we can't know
|
||
where the symbol will end up. So, we create a relocation
|
||
record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
|
||
linker. */
|
||
value = addend;
|
||
if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
|
||
info,
|
||
relocation,
|
||
h,
|
||
sec,
|
||
symbol,
|
||
&value,
|
||
input_section))
|
||
return bfd_reloc_undefined;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
|
||
value = symbol + addend;
|
||
else
|
||
value = addend;
|
||
}
|
||
value &= howto->dst_mask;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_PC32:
|
||
case R_MIPS_PC64:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GNU_REL_LO16:
|
||
value = symbol + addend - p;
|
||
value &= howto->dst_mask;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
|
||
value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18) - p;
|
||
overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
|
||
value = (value >> 2) & howto->dst_mask;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16:
|
||
/* Instead of subtracting 'p' here, we should be subtracting the
|
||
equivalent value for the LO part of the reloc, since the value
|
||
here is relative to that address. Because that's not easy to do,
|
||
we adjust 'addend' in _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section(). See also
|
||
the comment there for more information. */
|
||
value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - p);
|
||
value &= howto->dst_mask;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS16_26:
|
||
/* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
|
||
R_MIPS_26. It's only the storage of the relocated field into
|
||
the output file that's different. That's handled in
|
||
mips_elf_perform_relocation. So, we just fall through to the
|
||
R_MIPS_26 case here. */
|
||
case R_MIPS_26:
|
||
if (local_p)
|
||
value = ((addend | ((p + 4) & 0xf0000000)) + symbol) >> 2;
|
||
else
|
||
value = (_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28) + symbol) >> 2;
|
||
value &= howto->dst_mask;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_HI16:
|
||
if (!gp_disp_p)
|
||
{
|
||
value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
|
||
value &= howto->dst_mask;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
|
||
overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_LO16:
|
||
if (!gp_disp_p)
|
||
value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
value = addend + gp - p + 4;
|
||
/* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
|
||
for overflow. But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
|
||
_gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
|
||
pseudo-op. It generates code that normally looks like
|
||
this:
|
||
|
||
lui $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
|
||
addiu $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
|
||
addu $gp,$gp,$t9
|
||
|
||
Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
|
||
as required by the MIPS ELF ABI. The R_MIPS_LO16
|
||
relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
|
||
R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
|
||
Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
|
||
not check for overflow here. */
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
|
||
/* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
|
||
just like R_MIPS_GPREL16. In the long run, we should merge
|
||
shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
|
||
here. */
|
||
|
||
/* Fall through. */
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
|
||
/* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
|
||
R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
|
||
order. We don't need to do anything special here; the
|
||
differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation. */
|
||
case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
|
||
/* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
|
||
instruction. If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
|
||
otherwise we may lose significant bits. */
|
||
if (howto->partial_inplace)
|
||
addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
|
||
value = symbol + addend - gp;
|
||
/* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
|
||
have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
|
||
for that now. Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
|
||
link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
|
||
to them before. */
|
||
if (was_local_p)
|
||
value += gp0;
|
||
overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL16:
|
||
if (local_p)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_boolean forced;
|
||
|
||
/* The special case is when the symbol is forced to be local. We
|
||
need the full address in the GOT since no R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
|
||
follows. */
|
||
forced = ! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
|
||
local_sections, FALSE);
|
||
value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
|
||
symbol + addend, forced);
|
||
if (value == MINUS_ONE)
|
||
return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
|
||
value
|
||
= mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
|
||
abfd, input_bfd, value);
|
||
overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Fall through. */
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
|
||
got_disp:
|
||
value = g;
|
||
overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
|
||
value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
|
||
if (!save_addend)
|
||
value &= howto->dst_mask;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_PC16:
|
||
value = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16) + symbol - p;
|
||
overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
|
||
/* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
|
||
The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
|
||
differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub. */
|
||
value = g;
|
||
value = mips_elf_high (value);
|
||
value &= howto->dst_mask;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
|
||
value = g & howto->dst_mask;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
|
||
/* GOT_PAGE relocations that reference non-local symbols decay
|
||
to GOT_DISP. The corresponding GOT_OFST relocation decays to
|
||
0. */
|
||
if (! local_p)
|
||
goto got_disp;
|
||
value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
|
||
if (value == MINUS_ONE)
|
||
return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
|
||
value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
|
||
abfd, input_bfd, value);
|
||
overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
|
||
if (local_p)
|
||
mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
|
||
else
|
||
value = addend;
|
||
overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_SUB:
|
||
value = symbol - addend;
|
||
value &= howto->dst_mask;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
|
||
value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
|
||
value &= howto->dst_mask;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
|
||
value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
|
||
value &= howto->dst_mask;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
|
||
value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
|
||
value &= howto->dst_mask;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
|
||
case R_MIPS_JALR:
|
||
/* Both of these may be ignored. R_MIPS_JALR is an optimization
|
||
hint; we could improve performance by honoring that hint. */
|
||
return bfd_reloc_continue;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
|
||
/* We don't do anything with these at present. */
|
||
return bfd_reloc_continue;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
/* An unrecognized relocation type. */
|
||
return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Store the VALUE for our caller. */
|
||
*valuep = value;
|
||
return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_vma
|
||
mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
|
||
bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_vma x;
|
||
bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
|
||
|
||
/* Obtain the bytes. */
|
||
x = bfd_get ((8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto)), input_bfd, location);
|
||
|
||
if ((ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info) == R_MIPS16_26
|
||
|| ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info) == R_MIPS16_GPREL)
|
||
&& bfd_little_endian (input_bfd))
|
||
/* The two 16-bit words will be reversed on a little-endian system.
|
||
See mips_elf_perform_relocation for more details. */
|
||
x = (((x & 0xffff) << 16) | ((x & 0xffff0000) >> 16));
|
||
|
||
return x;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
|
||
VALUE. Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
|
||
appropriate position. The SECTION is the section to which the
|
||
relocation applies. If REQUIRE_JALX is TRUE, then the opcode used
|
||
for the relocation must be either JAL or JALX, and it is
|
||
unconditionally converted to JALX.
|
||
|
||
Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
reloc_howto_type *howto,
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
|
||
bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
|
||
asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
|
||
bfd_boolean require_jalx)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_vma x;
|
||
bfd_byte *location;
|
||
int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
|
||
|
||
/* Figure out where the relocation is occurring. */
|
||
location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
|
||
|
||
/* Obtain the current value. */
|
||
x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
|
||
|
||
/* Clear the field we are setting. */
|
||
x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
|
||
|
||
/* If this is the R_MIPS16_26 relocation, we must store the
|
||
value in a funny way. */
|
||
if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
|
||
{
|
||
/* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
|
||
Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
|
||
are 32 bits.
|
||
|
||
The format of these instructions is:
|
||
|
||
+--------------+--------------------------------+
|
||
! JALX ! X! Imm 20:16 ! Imm 25:21 !
|
||
+--------------+--------------------------------+
|
||
! Immediate 15:0 !
|
||
+-----------------------------------------------+
|
||
|
||
JALX is the 5-bit value 00011. X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
|
||
Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
|
||
|
||
When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
|
||
handled mostly like R_MIPS_26. In particular, the addend is
|
||
stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
|
||
(gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
|
||
R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
|
||
always zero). However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
|
||
16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value. In a
|
||
big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
|
||
file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
|
||
This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
|
||
instruction.
|
||
|
||
When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
|
||
instruction stored as two 16-bit values. The addend A is the
|
||
contents of the targ26 field. The calculation is the same as
|
||
R_MIPS_26. When storing the calculated value, reorder the
|
||
immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
|
||
value as two 16-bit values.
|
||
|
||
To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
|
||
defined as
|
||
|
||
big-endian:
|
||
+--------+----------------------+
|
||
| | |
|
||
| | targ26-16 |
|
||
|31 26|25 0|
|
||
+--------+----------------------+
|
||
|
||
little-endian:
|
||
+----------+------+-------------+
|
||
| | | |
|
||
| sub1 | | sub2 |
|
||
|0 9|10 15|16 31|
|
||
+----------+--------------------+
|
||
where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
|
||
((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
|
||
|
||
When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
|
||
(((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
|
||
When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
|
||
let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
|
||
((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff) */
|
||
|
||
if (!info->relocatable)
|
||
/* Shuffle the bits according to the formula above. */
|
||
value = (((value & 0x1f0000) << 5)
|
||
| ((value & 0x3e00000) >> 5)
|
||
| (value & 0xffff));
|
||
}
|
||
else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* R_MIPS16_GPREL is used for GP-relative addressing in mips16
|
||
mode. A typical instruction will have a format like this:
|
||
|
||
+--------------+--------------------------------+
|
||
! EXTEND ! Imm 10:5 ! Imm 15:11 !
|
||
+--------------+--------------------------------+
|
||
! Major ! rx ! ry ! Imm 4:0 !
|
||
+--------------+--------------------------------+
|
||
|
||
EXTEND is the five bit value 11110. Major is the instruction
|
||
opcode.
|
||
|
||
This is handled exactly like R_MIPS_GPREL16, except that the
|
||
addend is retrieved and stored as shown in this diagram; that
|
||
is, the Imm fields above replace the V-rel16 field.
|
||
|
||
All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately. As
|
||
above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
|
||
little-endian system. */
|
||
value = (((value & 0x7e0) << 16)
|
||
| ((value & 0xf800) << 5)
|
||
| (value & 0x1f));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Set the field. */
|
||
x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
|
||
|
||
/* If required, turn JAL into JALX. */
|
||
if (require_jalx)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_boolean ok;
|
||
bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
|
||
bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
|
||
|
||
/* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX. */
|
||
if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
|
||
{
|
||
ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
|
||
jalx_opcode = 0x7;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
|
||
jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem. */
|
||
if (!ok)
|
||
{
|
||
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
||
(_("%s: %s+0x%lx: jump to stub routine which is not jal"),
|
||
bfd_archive_filename (input_bfd),
|
||
input_section->name,
|
||
(unsigned long) relocation->r_offset);
|
||
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Make this the JALX opcode. */
|
||
x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Swap the high- and low-order 16 bits on little-endian systems
|
||
when doing a MIPS16 relocation. */
|
||
if ((r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL || r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
|
||
&& bfd_little_endian (input_bfd))
|
||
x = (((x & 0xffff) << 16) | ((x & 0xffff0000) >> 16));
|
||
|
||
/* Put the value into the output. */
|
||
bfd_put (8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto), input_bfd, x, location);
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns TRUE if SECTION is a MIPS16 stub section. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_stub_section_p (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section)
|
||
{
|
||
const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, section);
|
||
|
||
return (strncmp (name, FN_STUB, sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0
|
||
|| strncmp (name, CALL_STUB, sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0
|
||
|| strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add room for N relocations to the .rel.dyn section in ABFD. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, unsigned int n)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *s;
|
||
|
||
s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (abfd, FALSE);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
||
|
||
if (s->_raw_size == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Make room for a null element. */
|
||
s->_raw_size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
|
||
++s->reloc_count;
|
||
}
|
||
s->_raw_size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve. REL
|
||
is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
|
||
dynamic relocation. The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
|
||
caller should store the result in place of the original addend. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
|
||
asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
|
||
bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
|
||
bfd_boolean skip;
|
||
asection *sreloc;
|
||
bfd *dynobj;
|
||
int r_type;
|
||
|
||
r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
|
||
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
||
sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
|
||
< sreloc->_raw_size);
|
||
|
||
skip = FALSE;
|
||
outrel[0].r_offset =
|
||
_bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
|
||
outrel[1].r_offset =
|
||
_bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
|
||
outrel[2].r_offset =
|
||
_bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* We begin by assuming that the offset for the dynamic relocation
|
||
is the same as for the original relocation. We'll adjust this
|
||
later to reflect the correct output offsets. */
|
||
if (input_section->sec_info_type != ELF_INFO_TYPE_STABS)
|
||
{
|
||
outrel[1].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset;
|
||
outrel[2].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Except that in a stab section things are more complex.
|
||
Because we compress stab information, the offset given in the
|
||
relocation may not be the one we want; we must let the stabs
|
||
machinery tell us the offset. */
|
||
outrel[1].r_offset = outrel[0].r_offset;
|
||
outrel[2].r_offset = outrel[0].r_offset;
|
||
/* If we didn't need the relocation at all, this value will be
|
||
-1. */
|
||
if (outrel[0].r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
|
||
skip = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
if (outrel[0].r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1)
|
||
/* The relocation field has been deleted. */
|
||
skip = TRUE;
|
||
else if (outrel[0].r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
|
||
{
|
||
/* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
|
||
some sort. Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
|
||
the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value. */
|
||
skip = TRUE;
|
||
*addendp += symbol;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we've decided to skip this relocation, just output an empty
|
||
record. Note that R_MIPS_NONE == 0, so that this call to memset
|
||
is a way of setting R_TYPE to R_MIPS_NONE. */
|
||
if (skip)
|
||
memset (outrel, 0, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela) * 3);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
long indx;
|
||
bfd_boolean defined_p;
|
||
|
||
/* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
|
||
in the relocation. */
|
||
if (h != NULL
|
||
&& (! info->symbolic || (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)
|
||
/* h->root.dynindx may be -1 if this symbol was marked to
|
||
become local. */
|
||
&& h->root.dynindx != -1)
|
||
{
|
||
indx = h->root.dynindx;
|
||
if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
|
||
defined_p = ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) != 0);
|
||
else
|
||
/* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
|
||
relocation field. It therefore treats relocs against
|
||
defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
|
||
undefined symbols. */
|
||
defined_p = FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
|
||
indx = 0;
|
||
else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
|
||
if (indx == 0)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
|
||
symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
|
||
relocation. We want to avoid generating relocations to
|
||
local symbols because we used to generate them
|
||
incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
|
||
which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols. In
|
||
order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
|
||
phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
|
||
section-relative relocations. It's not like they're
|
||
useful, after all. This should be a bit more efficient
|
||
as well. */
|
||
/* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
|
||
the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
|
||
a symbol value of 0. Irix rld honors this, so relocations
|
||
against STN_UNDEF have no effect. */
|
||
if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
|
||
indx = 0;
|
||
defined_p = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
|
||
this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
|
||
adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
|
||
Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker. */
|
||
if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
|
||
*addendp += symbol;
|
||
|
||
/* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
|
||
know where the shared library will wind up at load-time. */
|
||
outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
|
||
R_MIPS_REL32);
|
||
/* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
|
||
generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
|
||
_REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
|
||
a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
|
||
However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
|
||
loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
|
||
artificial relocations. If this turns out to not be true,
|
||
mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
|
||
as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
|
||
invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
|
||
additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
|
||
NULL symbol before this relocation record. */
|
||
outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
|
||
ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
|
||
? R_MIPS_64
|
||
: R_MIPS_NONE);
|
||
outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
|
||
|
||
/* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
|
||
correct location in the output file. */
|
||
outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
|
||
+ input_section->output_offset);
|
||
outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
|
||
+ input_section->output_offset);
|
||
outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
|
||
+ input_section->output_offset);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Put the relocation back out. We have to use the special
|
||
relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
|
||
relocation format is non-standard. */
|
||
if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
|
||
{
|
||
(*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
|
||
(output_bfd, &outrel[0],
|
||
(sreloc->contents
|
||
+ sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
|
||
(output_bfd, &outrel[0],
|
||
(sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
|
||
|
||
/* We've now added another relocation. */
|
||
++sreloc->reloc_count;
|
||
|
||
/* Make sure the output section is writable. The dynamic linker
|
||
will be writing to it. */
|
||
elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
|
||
|= SHF_WRITE;
|
||
|
||
/* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info. */
|
||
if (! skip && IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *scpt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
|
||
bfd_byte *cr;
|
||
|
||
if (scpt)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
|
||
|
||
mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
|
||
cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
|
||
+ input_section->output_section->vma
|
||
+ input_section->output_offset);
|
||
if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
|
||
mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
|
||
else
|
||
mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
|
||
mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
|
||
cptrel.konst = *addendp;
|
||
|
||
cr = (scpt->contents
|
||
+ sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
|
||
bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
|
||
((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
|
||
+ scpt->reloc_count));
|
||
++scpt->reloc_count;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value. */
|
||
|
||
unsigned long
|
||
_bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
|
||
{
|
||
switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
|
||
{
|
||
case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips3900;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips4010;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips4100;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips4111;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips4120;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips4650;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips5400;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips5500;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips9000;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips_octeon;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
|
||
{
|
||
default:
|
||
case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips3000;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips6000;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips4000;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips8000;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mips5;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
|
||
return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return printable name for ABI. */
|
||
|
||
static INLINE char *
|
||
elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
|
||
{
|
||
flagword flags;
|
||
|
||
flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
|
||
switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
|
||
{
|
||
case 0:
|
||
if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
|
||
return "N32";
|
||
else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
|
||
return "64";
|
||
else
|
||
return "none";
|
||
case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
|
||
return "O32";
|
||
case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
|
||
return "O64";
|
||
case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
|
||
return "EABI32";
|
||
case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
|
||
return "EABI64";
|
||
default:
|
||
return "unknown abi";
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* MIPS ELF uses two common sections. One is the usual one, and the
|
||
other is for small objects. All the small objects are kept
|
||
together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
|
||
faster assembler code. This is what we use for the small common
|
||
section. This approach is copied from ecoff.c. */
|
||
static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
|
||
static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
|
||
static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
|
||
|
||
/* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
|
||
allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
|
||
definition in a shared library. */
|
||
static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
|
||
static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
|
||
static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
|
||
|
||
/* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use.
|
||
This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
|
||
{
|
||
elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
|
||
|
||
elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
|
||
switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
|
||
{
|
||
case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
|
||
/* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
|
||
It is an allocated common section. The dynamic linker can
|
||
either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
|
||
library, or it can just leave them here. For our purposes,
|
||
we can consider these symbols to be in a new section. */
|
||
if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Initialize the acommon section. */
|
||
mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
|
||
mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
|
||
mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
|
||
mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
|
||
mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
|
||
mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
|
||
mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
|
||
mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
|
||
mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
|
||
}
|
||
asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SHN_COMMON:
|
||
/* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
|
||
treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5. */
|
||
if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
|
||
|| IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
|
||
break;
|
||
/* Fall through. */
|
||
case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
|
||
if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Initialize the small common section. */
|
||
mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
|
||
mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
|
||
mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
|
||
mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
|
||
mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
|
||
mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
|
||
mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
|
||
mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
|
||
mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
|
||
}
|
||
asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
|
||
asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
|
||
asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
#if 0 /* for SGI_COMPAT */
|
||
case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
|
||
asym->section = mips_elf_text_section_ptr;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
|
||
asym->section = mips_elf_data_section_ptr;
|
||
break;
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
|
||
relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
|
||
same address. For example, if we have code like:
|
||
|
||
lw $4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
|
||
lw $25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
|
||
jalr $25
|
||
|
||
then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
|
||
will jump there rather than to .text.
|
||
|
||
We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
|
||
This is also what the MIPSpro tools do. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
|
||
{
|
||
return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Work over a section just before writing it out. This routine is
|
||
used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. FIXME: We recognize
|
||
sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
|
||
a better way. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
|
||
{
|
||
if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
|
||
&& hdr->sh_size > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_byte buf[4];
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
|
||
|
||
if (bfd_seek (abfd,
|
||
hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
|
||
SEEK_SET) != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
|
||
if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
|
||
&& hdr->bfd_section != NULL
|
||
&& mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
|
||
&& mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
|
||
|
||
/* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
|
||
set_section_contents routine. We save the section contents
|
||
so that we don't have to read them again.
|
||
At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
|
||
through the section contents to see if there is an
|
||
ODK_REGINFO structure. */
|
||
|
||
contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
|
||
l = contents;
|
||
lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
|
||
while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
|
||
|
||
bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
|
||
&intopt);
|
||
if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_byte buf[8];
|
||
|
||
if (bfd_seek (abfd,
|
||
(hdr->sh_offset
|
||
+ (l - contents)
|
||
+ sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
|
||
+ (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
|
||
SEEK_SET) != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
|
||
if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_byte buf[4];
|
||
|
||
if (bfd_seek (abfd,
|
||
(hdr->sh_offset
|
||
+ (l - contents)
|
||
+ sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
|
||
+ (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
|
||
SEEK_SET) != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
|
||
if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
l += intopt.size;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
|
||
|
||
if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_flags = 0;
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int adjust;
|
||
|
||
adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
|
||
if (adjust != 0)
|
||
hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file. This
|
||
is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
|
||
This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
|
||
|
||
FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
|
||
how to. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
|
||
const char *name)
|
||
{
|
||
flagword flags = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
|
||
at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the
|
||
sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives
|
||
suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
|
||
probably get away with this. */
|
||
switch (hdr->sh_type)
|
||
{
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
|
||
if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
|
||
if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
|
||
if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
|
||
if (strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
|
||
if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
|
||
if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
|
||
break;
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
|
||
if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
|
||
|| hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
|
||
break;
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
|
||
if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
|
||
if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content", sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1) != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
|
||
if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
|
||
if (strncmp (name, ".debug_", sizeof ".debug_" - 1) != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
|
||
if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
|
||
if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) != 0
|
||
&& strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel",
|
||
sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (flags)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
|
||
(bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
|
||
hdr->bfd_section)
|
||
| flags)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section. */
|
||
|
||
/* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
|
||
from the contents of this section. We need the gp value while
|
||
processing relocs, so we just get it now. The .reginfo section
|
||
is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI. */
|
||
if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
|
||
Elf32_RegInfo s;
|
||
|
||
if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
|
||
&ext, 0, sizeof ext))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
|
||
elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
|
||
set the gp value based on what we find. We may see both
|
||
SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
|
||
they should agree. */
|
||
if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
|
||
|
||
contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
|
||
if (contents == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
|
||
0, hdr->sh_size))
|
||
{
|
||
free (contents);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
l = contents;
|
||
lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
|
||
while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
|
||
|
||
bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
|
||
&intopt);
|
||
if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
|
||
|
||
bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
|
||
(abfd,
|
||
((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
|
||
(l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
|
||
&intreg);
|
||
elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
|
||
|
||
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
|
||
(abfd,
|
||
((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
|
||
(l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
|
||
&intreg);
|
||
elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
|
||
}
|
||
l += intopt.size;
|
||
}
|
||
free (contents);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section. We do this by the
|
||
section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. This routine is
|
||
used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
|
||
{
|
||
register const char *name;
|
||
|
||
name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
|
||
|
||
if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
|
||
hdr->sh_info = sec->_raw_size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
|
||
/* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
|
||
else if (strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
|
||
hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
|
||
/* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
|
||
/* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
|
||
entsize of 0. FIXME: Does this matter? */
|
||
if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
|
||
hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
|
||
else
|
||
hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
|
||
/* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
|
||
entsize of 0x18. FIXME: Does this matter? */
|
||
if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
|
||
{
|
||
if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
|
||
hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
|
||
else
|
||
hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
|
||
&& (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
|
||
{
|
||
if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
|
||
hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves. */
|
||
hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
|
||
hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
|
||
hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content", strlen (".MIPS.content")) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
|
||
hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
|
||
/* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
|
||
hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
|
||
hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strncmp (name, ".debug_", sizeof ".debug_" - 1) == 0)
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
|
||
/* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
|
||
final_write_processing. */
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) == 0
|
||
|| strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel",
|
||
sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
|
||
hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
|
||
/* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
|
||
hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
|
||
hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
|
||
kind of relocations. We used to set up a second header for the
|
||
non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
|
||
these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
|
||
Thus we create those header only on demand now. */
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
|
||
index. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
|
||
Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
|
||
but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
|
||
the .scommon section. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
||
asection *sec, int *retval)
|
||
{
|
||
if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
*retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
*retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
|
||
file. We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
|
||
flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
||
asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
|
||
{
|
||
if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
|
||
&& (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
|
||
&& strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name. */
|
||
*namep = NULL;
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
switch (sym->st_shndx)
|
||
{
|
||
case SHN_COMMON:
|
||
/* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
|
||
treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols. */
|
||
if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
|
||
|| IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
|
||
break;
|
||
/* Fall through. */
|
||
case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
|
||
*secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
|
||
(*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
|
||
*valp = sym->st_size;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
|
||
/* This section is used in a shared object. */
|
||
if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
|
||
asection *elf_text_section;
|
||
bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
|
||
|
||
elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (elf_text_section == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
amt = sizeof (asymbol);
|
||
elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Initialize the section. */
|
||
|
||
elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
|
||
elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
|
||
|
||
elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
|
||
elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
|
||
|
||
elf_text_section->name = ".text";
|
||
elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
|
||
elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
|
||
elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
|
||
elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
|
||
elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
|
||
elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
|
||
}
|
||
/* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
|
||
info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
|
||
so I took it out. */
|
||
*secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
|
||
/* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data? */
|
||
case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
|
||
/* This section is used in a shared object. */
|
||
if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
|
||
asection *elf_data_section;
|
||
bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
|
||
|
||
elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (elf_data_section == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
amt = sizeof (asymbol);
|
||
elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Initialize the section. */
|
||
|
||
elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
|
||
elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
|
||
|
||
elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
|
||
elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
|
||
|
||
elf_data_section->name = ".data";
|
||
elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
|
||
elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
|
||
elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
|
||
elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
|
||
elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
|
||
elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
|
||
}
|
||
/* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
|
||
info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
|
||
so I took it out. */
|
||
*secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
|
||
*secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
|
||
&& ! info->shared
|
||
&& info->hash->creator == abfd->xvec
|
||
&& strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
||
struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
|
||
|
||
/* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic. */
|
||
bh = NULL;
|
||
if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
|
||
(info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
|
||
get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
|
||
h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF;
|
||
h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR;
|
||
h->type = STT_OBJECT;
|
||
|
||
if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
|
||
odd. This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
|
||
the right value when it is loaded into the PC. */
|
||
if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
|
||
++*valp;
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
|
||
symbol. We mark symbols as small common if appropriate. This is
|
||
also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
|
||
(struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
||
const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
|
||
asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
|
||
if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
|
||
common in the output file. */
|
||
if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
|
||
&& strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
|
||
sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
|
||
|
||
if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16
|
||
&& (sym->st_value & 1) != 0)
|
||
--sym->st_value;
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Functions for the dynamic linker. */
|
||
|
||
/* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
||
{
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
||
struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
|
||
flagword flags;
|
||
register asection *s;
|
||
const char * const *namep;
|
||
|
||
flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
|
||
| SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
|
||
|
||
/* Mips ABI requests the .dynamic section to be read only. */
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
|
||
if (s != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We need to create .got section. */
|
||
if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info, FALSE))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, TRUE))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Create .stub section. */
|
||
if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
|
||
MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
s = bfd_make_section (abfd, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd));
|
||
if (s == NULL
|
||
|| ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags | SEC_CODE)
|
||
|| ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
|
||
MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if ((IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
|
||
&& !info->shared
|
||
&& bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
s = bfd_make_section (abfd, ".rld_map");
|
||
if (s == NULL
|
||
|| ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY)
|
||
|| ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
|
||
MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
|
||
alignments of several sections. There is no ABI documentation
|
||
indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
|
||
the linker takes such action. */
|
||
if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
|
||
{
|
||
for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
|
||
{
|
||
bh = NULL;
|
||
if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
|
||
(info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
|
||
NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
|
||
h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF;
|
||
h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR;
|
||
h->type = STT_SECTION;
|
||
|
||
if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We need to create a .compact_rel section. */
|
||
if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Change alignments of some sections. */
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".hash");
|
||
if (s != NULL)
|
||
bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
|
||
if (s != NULL)
|
||
bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
|
||
if (s != NULL)
|
||
bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
|
||
if (s != NULL)
|
||
bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
|
||
if (s != NULL)
|
||
bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (!info->shared)
|
||
{
|
||
const char *name;
|
||
|
||
name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
|
||
bh = NULL;
|
||
if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
|
||
(info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
|
||
NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
|
||
h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF;
|
||
h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR;
|
||
h->type = STT_SECTION;
|
||
|
||
if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
|
||
{
|
||
/* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
|
||
and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
|
||
the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol. */
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map");
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
||
|
||
name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
|
||
bh = NULL;
|
||
if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
|
||
(info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
|
||
get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
|
||
h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF;
|
||
h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR;
|
||
h->type = STT_OBJECT;
|
||
|
||
if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
|
||
allocate space in the global offset table. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
|
||
{
|
||
const char *name;
|
||
bfd *dynobj;
|
||
Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
size_t extsymoff;
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
|
||
asection *sgot;
|
||
asection *sreloc;
|
||
const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
|
||
|
||
if (info->relocatable)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
||
symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
|
||
sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
|
||
extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
|
||
|
||
/* Check for the mips16 stub sections. */
|
||
|
||
name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
|
||
if (strncmp (name, FN_STUB, sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long r_symndx;
|
||
|
||
/* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
|
||
this is for. */
|
||
|
||
r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
|
||
|
||
if (r_symndx < extsymoff
|
||
|| sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *o;
|
||
|
||
/* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
|
||
needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
|
||
than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol. */
|
||
for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
|
||
|
||
/* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
|
||
if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
|
||
|| o->reloc_count == 0
|
||
|| strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), FN_STUB,
|
||
sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0
|
||
|| strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), CALL_STUB,
|
||
sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0
|
||
|| strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), CALL_FP_STUB,
|
||
sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
sec_relocs
|
||
= _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
|
||
info->keep_memory);
|
||
if (sec_relocs == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
|
||
for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
|
||
if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
|
||
&& ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) != R_MIPS16_26)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
|
||
free (sec_relocs);
|
||
|
||
if (r < rend)
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (o == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
|
||
not need it. Since this function is called before
|
||
the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
|
||
can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
|
||
flag. */
|
||
sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
|
||
this BFD. */
|
||
if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long symcount;
|
||
asection **n;
|
||
bfd_size_type amt;
|
||
|
||
if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
|
||
symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
|
||
else
|
||
symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
|
||
amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
|
||
n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (n == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
|
||
|
||
/* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
|
||
That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
|
||
the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
|
||
it here, because we just have a local stub. */
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
||
|
||
h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
|
||
sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
|
||
|
||
/* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
|
||
|
||
h->fn_stub = sec;
|
||
mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strncmp (name, CALL_STUB, sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0
|
||
|| strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long r_symndx;
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
||
asection **loc;
|
||
|
||
/* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
|
||
this is for. */
|
||
|
||
r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
|
||
|
||
if (r_symndx < extsymoff
|
||
|| sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* This stub was actually built for a static symbol defined
|
||
in the same file. We assume that all static symbols in
|
||
mips16 code are themselves mips16, so we can simply
|
||
discard this stub. Since this function is called before
|
||
the linker maps input sections to output sections, we can
|
||
easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
|
||
sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
|
||
sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
|
||
|
||
/* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
|
||
|
||
if (strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
|
||
loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
|
||
else
|
||
loc = &h->call_stub;
|
||
|
||
/* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
|
||
don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
|
||
this function is called before the linker maps input sections
|
||
to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
|
||
SEC_EXCLUDE flag. We can also discard this section if we
|
||
happen to already know that this is a mips16 function; it is
|
||
not necessary to check this here, as it is checked later, but
|
||
it is slightly faster to check now. */
|
||
if (*loc != NULL || h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
|
||
{
|
||
sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
*loc = sec;
|
||
mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (dynobj == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
sgot = NULL;
|
||
g = NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
|
||
if (sgot == NULL)
|
||
g = NULL;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
|
||
g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
sreloc = NULL;
|
||
bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
|
||
rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
|
||
for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long r_symndx;
|
||
unsigned int r_type;
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
||
|
||
r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
|
||
r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
|
||
|
||
if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
|
||
h = NULL;
|
||
else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
|
||
{
|
||
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
||
(_("%s: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
|
||
bfd_archive_filename (abfd), name);
|
||
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
|
||
|
||
/* This may be an indirect symbol created because of a version. */
|
||
if (h != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
|
||
h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Some relocs require a global offset table. */
|
||
if (dynobj == NULL || sgot == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
switch (r_type)
|
||
{
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
|
||
if (dynobj == NULL)
|
||
elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
|
||
if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, FALSE))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_32:
|
||
case R_MIPS_REL32:
|
||
case R_MIPS_64:
|
||
if (dynobj == NULL
|
||
&& (info->shared || h != NULL)
|
||
&& (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
|
||
elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (!h && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
|
||
|| r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16
|
||
|| r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP))
|
||
{
|
||
/* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation. We
|
||
don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
|
||
maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
|
||
the segment. Similar comments apply to R_MIPS_GOT16 and
|
||
R_MIPS_CALL16. We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
|
||
R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
|
||
R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16. */
|
||
if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
|
||
rel->r_addend, g))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
switch (r_type)
|
||
{
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL16:
|
||
if (h == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
||
(_("%s: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"),
|
||
bfd_archive_filename (abfd), (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
|
||
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
/* Fall through. */
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
|
||
if (h != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
|
||
if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
|
||
function. But we record it as if it needs plt. See
|
||
_bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
|
||
h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT;
|
||
h->type = STT_FUNC;
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
|
||
/* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
|
||
decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it. */
|
||
if (h == NULL)
|
||
break;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
|
||
(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
||
|
||
while (hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
|
||
|| hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
||
hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
|
||
hmips->root.root.u.i.link;
|
||
|
||
if ((hmips->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR)
|
||
&& ! (info->shared && ! info->symbolic
|
||
&& ! (hmips->root.elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_FORCED_LOCAL)))
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
/* Fall through. */
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
|
||
/* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
|
||
if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_32:
|
||
case R_MIPS_REL32:
|
||
case R_MIPS_64:
|
||
if ((info->shared || h != NULL)
|
||
&& (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (sreloc == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, TRUE);
|
||
if (sreloc == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
#define MIPS_READONLY_SECTION (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY)
|
||
if (info->shared)
|
||
{
|
||
/* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
|
||
reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
|
||
relocs. We make room for this reloc in the
|
||
.rel.dyn reloc section. */
|
||
mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, 1);
|
||
if ((sec->flags & MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
|
||
== MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
|
||
/* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
|
||
relocations against the text segment. */
|
||
info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
|
||
|
||
/* We only need to copy this reloc if the symbol is
|
||
defined in a dynamic object. */
|
||
hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
||
++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
|
||
if ((sec->flags & MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
|
||
== MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
|
||
/* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
|
||
are relocations against the text segment. */
|
||
hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for
|
||
this symbol, a symbol must have a dynamic symbol
|
||
table index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are
|
||
dynamic relocations against it. */
|
||
if (h != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
if (dynobj == NULL)
|
||
elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
|
||
if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, TRUE))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
|
||
if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
|
||
mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
|
||
sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case R_MIPS_26:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
|
||
if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
|
||
mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
|
||
sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
|
||
Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
|
||
case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
|
||
if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
|
||
used. Record for later use during GC. */
|
||
case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
|
||
if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
|
||
related to taking the function's address. */
|
||
switch (r_type)
|
||
{
|
||
default:
|
||
if (h != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
|
||
|
||
mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
||
mh->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_JALR:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this reloc is not a 16 bit call, and it has a global
|
||
symbol, then we will need the fn_stub if there is one.
|
||
References from a stub section do not count. */
|
||
if (h != NULL
|
||
&& r_type != R_MIPS16_26
|
||
&& strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), FN_STUB,
|
||
sizeof FN_STUB - 1) != 0
|
||
&& strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), CALL_STUB,
|
||
sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) != 0
|
||
&& strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), CALL_FP_STUB,
|
||
sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
|
||
|
||
mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
||
mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
|
||
bfd_boolean *again)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
|
||
Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
|
||
Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
|
||
bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
|
||
bfd_byte *free_contents = NULL;
|
||
size_t extsymoff;
|
||
bfd_boolean changed_contents = FALSE;
|
||
bfd_vma sec_start = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
|
||
Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
|
||
|
||
/* We are not currently changing any sizes, so only one pass. */
|
||
*again = FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (link_info->relocatable)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
|
||
link_info->keep_memory);
|
||
if (internal_relocs == NULL)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count
|
||
* get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
|
||
symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
|
||
extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
|
||
|
||
for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_vma symval;
|
||
bfd_signed_vma sym_offset;
|
||
unsigned int r_type;
|
||
unsigned long r_symndx;
|
||
asection *sym_sec;
|
||
unsigned long instruction;
|
||
|
||
/* Turn jalr into bgezal, and jr into beq, if they're marked
|
||
with a JALR relocation, that indicate where they jump to.
|
||
This saves some pipeline bubbles. */
|
||
r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, irel->r_info);
|
||
if (r_type != R_MIPS_JALR)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, irel->r_info);
|
||
/* Compute the address of the jump target. */
|
||
if (r_symndx >= extsymoff)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h
|
||
= ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
|
||
elf_sym_hashes (abfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
|
||
|
||
while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
|
||
|| h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
|
||
h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
|
||
|
||
/* If a symbol is undefined, or if it may be overridden,
|
||
skip it. */
|
||
if (! ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
|
||
|| h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
|
||
&& h->root.root.u.def.section)
|
||
|| (link_info->shared && ! link_info->symbolic
|
||
&& ! (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_FORCED_LOCAL)))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
sym_sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
|
||
if (sym_sec->output_section)
|
||
symval = (h->root.root.u.def.value
|
||
+ sym_sec->output_section->vma
|
||
+ sym_sec->output_offset);
|
||
else
|
||
symval = h->root.root.u.def.value;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
|
||
|
||
/* Read this BFD's symbols if we haven't done so already. */
|
||
if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
|
||
if (isymbuf == NULL)
|
||
isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
|
||
symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
|
||
NULL, NULL, NULL);
|
||
if (isymbuf == NULL)
|
||
goto relax_return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
|
||
if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
|
||
continue;
|
||
else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
|
||
sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
|
||
else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
|
||
sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
|
||
else
|
||
sym_sec
|
||
= bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
|
||
symval = isym->st_value
|
||
+ sym_sec->output_section->vma
|
||
+ sym_sec->output_offset;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Compute branch offset, from delay slot of the jump to the
|
||
branch target. */
|
||
sym_offset = (symval + irel->r_addend)
|
||
- (sec_start + irel->r_offset + 4);
|
||
|
||
/* Branch offset must be properly aligned. */
|
||
if ((sym_offset & 3) != 0)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
sym_offset >>= 2;
|
||
|
||
/* Check that it's in range. */
|
||
if (sym_offset < -0x8000 || sym_offset >= 0x8000)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
/* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
|
||
if (contents == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Get cached copy if it exists. */
|
||
if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
|
||
contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
contents = bfd_malloc (sec->_raw_size);
|
||
if (contents == NULL)
|
||
goto relax_return;
|
||
|
||
free_contents = contents;
|
||
if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, sec, contents,
|
||
0, sec->_raw_size))
|
||
goto relax_return;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
instruction = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
|
||
|
||
/* If it was jalr <reg>, turn it into bgezal $zero, <target>. */
|
||
if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x0000f809)
|
||
instruction = 0x04110000;
|
||
/* If it was jr <reg>, turn it into b <target>. */
|
||
else if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x00000008)
|
||
instruction = 0x10000000;
|
||
else
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
instruction |= (sym_offset & 0xffff);
|
||
bfd_put_32 (abfd, instruction, contents + irel->r_offset);
|
||
changed_contents = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (contents != NULL
|
||
&& elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
|
||
{
|
||
if (!changed_contents && !link_info->keep_memory)
|
||
free (contents);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
|
||
elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
relax_return:
|
||
if (free_contents != NULL)
|
||
free (free_contents);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
|
||
regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
|
||
dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
|
||
change the definition to something the rest of the link can
|
||
understand. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd *dynobj;
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
|
||
asection *s;
|
||
|
||
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
||
|
||
/* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
|
||
&& ((h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT)
|
||
|| h->weakdef != NULL
|
||
|| ((h->elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0
|
||
&& (h->elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_HASH_REF_REGULAR) != 0
|
||
&& (h->elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)));
|
||
|
||
/* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, we need to copy
|
||
any R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output
|
||
file. */
|
||
hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
||
if (! info->relocatable
|
||
&& hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
|
||
&& (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
|
||
|| (h->elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0))
|
||
{
|
||
mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj,
|
||
hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
|
||
if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
|
||
/* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
|
||
against the text segment. */
|
||
info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* For a function, create a stub, if allowed. */
|
||
if (! hmips->no_fn_stub
|
||
&& (h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
/* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
|
||
the symbol to the stub location. This is required to make
|
||
function pointers compare as equal between the normal
|
||
executable and the shared library. */
|
||
if ((h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We need .stub section. */
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
|
||
MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
||
|
||
h->root.u.def.section = s;
|
||
h->root.u.def.value = s->_raw_size;
|
||
|
||
/* XXX Write this stub address somewhere. */
|
||
h->plt.offset = s->_raw_size;
|
||
|
||
/* Make room for this stub code. */
|
||
s->_raw_size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE;
|
||
|
||
/* The last half word of the stub will be filled with the index
|
||
of this symbol in .dynsym section. */
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if ((h->type == STT_FUNC)
|
||
&& (h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* This will set the entry for this symbol in the GOT to 0, and
|
||
the dynamic linker will take care of this. */
|
||
h->root.u.def.value = 0;
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
|
||
processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
|
||
real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
|
||
if (h->weakdef != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (h->weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
|
||
|| h->weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
|
||
h->root.u.def.section = h->weakdef->root.u.def.section;
|
||
h->root.u.def.value = h->weakdef->root.u.def.value;
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
|
||
is not a function. */
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
|
||
and the input sections have been assigned to output sections. We
|
||
check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *ri;
|
||
|
||
bfd *dynobj;
|
||
asection *s;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
int i;
|
||
bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
|
||
bfd_size_type local_gotno;
|
||
bfd *sub;
|
||
|
||
/* The .reginfo section has a fixed size. */
|
||
ri = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
|
||
if (ri != NULL)
|
||
bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, ri, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
|
||
|
||
if (! (info->relocatable
|
||
|| ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen))
|
||
mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
|
||
mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs, NULL);
|
||
|
||
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
||
if (dynobj == NULL)
|
||
/* Relocatable links don't have it. */
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &s);
|
||
if (s == NULL)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
/* Calculate the total loadable size of the output. That
|
||
will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
|
||
required. */
|
||
for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub; sub = sub->link_next)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *subsection;
|
||
|
||
for (subsection = sub->sections;
|
||
subsection;
|
||
subsection = subsection->next)
|
||
{
|
||
if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
|
||
continue;
|
||
loadable_size += ((subsection->_raw_size + 0xf)
|
||
&~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* There has to be a global GOT entry for every symbol with
|
||
a dynamic symbol table index of DT_MIPS_GOTSYM or
|
||
higher. Therefore, it make sense to put those symbols
|
||
that need GOT entries at the end of the symbol table. We
|
||
do that here. */
|
||
if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
|
||
i = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - g->global_gotsym->dynindx;
|
||
else
|
||
/* If there are no global symbols, or none requiring
|
||
relocations, then GLOBAL_GOTSYM will be NULL. */
|
||
i = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* In the worst case, we'll get one stub per dynamic symbol, plus
|
||
one to account for the dummy entry at the end required by IRIX
|
||
rld. */
|
||
loadable_size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE * (i + 1);
|
||
|
||
/* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of
|
||
contiguous sections. Is 5 enough? */
|
||
local_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
|
||
|
||
g->local_gotno += local_gotno;
|
||
s->_raw_size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
|
||
|
||
g->global_gotno = i;
|
||
s->_raw_size += i * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
|
||
|
||
if (s->_raw_size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (output_bfd)
|
||
&& ! mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, g, s, local_gotno))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd *dynobj;
|
||
asection *s;
|
||
bfd_boolean reltext;
|
||
|
||
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
|
||
|
||
if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
|
||
if (info->executable)
|
||
{
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
||
s->_raw_size
|
||
= strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
|
||
s->contents
|
||
= (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
|
||
determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate
|
||
memory for them. */
|
||
reltext = FALSE;
|
||
for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
|
||
{
|
||
const char *name;
|
||
bfd_boolean strip;
|
||
|
||
/* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
|
||
of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
|
||
name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
|
||
|
||
if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
strip = FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (s->_raw_size == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We only strip the section if the output section name
|
||
has the same name. Otherwise, there might be several
|
||
input sections for this output section. FIXME: This
|
||
code is probably not needed these days anyhow, since
|
||
the linker now does not create empty output sections. */
|
||
if (s->output_section != NULL
|
||
&& strcmp (name,
|
||
bfd_get_section_name (s->output_section->owner,
|
||
s->output_section)) == 0)
|
||
strip = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
const char *outname;
|
||
asection *target;
|
||
|
||
/* If this relocation section applies to a read only
|
||
section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
|
||
If the relocation section is .rel.dyn, we always
|
||
assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
|
||
there exists a relocation to a read only section or
|
||
not. */
|
||
outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
|
||
s->output_section);
|
||
target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
|
||
if ((target != NULL
|
||
&& (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
|
||
&& (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
|
||
|| strcmp (outname, ".rel.dyn") == 0)
|
||
reltext = TRUE;
|
||
|
||
/* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
|
||
to copy relocs into the output file. */
|
||
if (strcmp (name, ".rel.dyn") != 0)
|
||
s->reloc_count = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
|
||
sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
|
||
and before we're done creating relocations. Also, it
|
||
will move them around between input sections'
|
||
relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
|
||
broken, so don't let it run. */
|
||
info->combreloc = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strncmp (name, ".got", 4) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections() has already done
|
||
most of the work, but some symbols may have been mapped
|
||
to versions that we must now resolve in the got_entries
|
||
hash tables. */
|
||
struct mips_got_info *gg = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g = gg;
|
||
struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
|
||
unsigned int needed_relocs = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (gg->next)
|
||
{
|
||
set_got_offset_arg.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
|
||
set_got_offset_arg.info = info;
|
||
|
||
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (gg);
|
||
for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int save_assign;
|
||
|
||
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
|
||
|
||
/* Assign offsets to global GOT entries. */
|
||
save_assign = g->assigned_gotno;
|
||
g->assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno;
|
||
set_got_offset_arg.g = g;
|
||
set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs = 0;
|
||
htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
|
||
mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
|
||
&set_got_offset_arg);
|
||
needed_relocs += set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs;
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno - g->local_gotno
|
||
<= g->global_gotno);
|
||
|
||
g->assigned_gotno = save_assign;
|
||
if (info->shared)
|
||
{
|
||
needed_relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_gotno;
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
|
||
+ g->next->global_gotno
|
||
+ MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (needed_relocs)
|
||
mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, needed_relocs);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* IRIX rld assumes that the function stub isn't at the end
|
||
of .text section. So put a dummy. XXX */
|
||
s->_raw_size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (! info->shared
|
||
&& ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
|
||
&& strncmp (name, ".rld_map", 8) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We add a room for __rld_map. It will be filled in by the
|
||
rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure. */
|
||
s->_raw_size += 4;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
|
||
&& strncmp (name, ".compact_rel", 12) == 0)
|
||
s->_raw_size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
|
||
else if (strncmp (name, ".init", 5) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (strip)
|
||
{
|
||
_bfd_strip_section_from_output (info, s);
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
|
||
s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->_raw_size);
|
||
if (s->contents == NULL && s->_raw_size != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
|
||
values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
|
||
must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
|
||
the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
|
||
dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
|
||
if (! info->shared)
|
||
{
|
||
/* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
|
||
DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry. */
|
||
if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Shared libraries on traditional mips have DT_DEBUG. */
|
||
if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (reltext && SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
|
||
info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
|
||
|
||
if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE))
|
||
{
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* Time stamps in executable files are a bad idea. */
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
#if 0 /* FIXME */
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
#if 0 /* FIXME */
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_IVERSION, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
|
||
&& ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
|
||
&& (bfd_get_section_by_name
|
||
(dynobj, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
|
||
&& !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Relocate a MIPS ELF section. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
|
||
bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
|
||
Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
|
||
asection **local_sections)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
|
||
bfd_vma addend = 0;
|
||
bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
|
||
const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
|
||
|
||
bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
|
||
relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
|
||
for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
|
||
{
|
||
const char *name;
|
||
bfd_vma value;
|
||
reloc_howto_type *howto;
|
||
bfd_boolean require_jalx;
|
||
/* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
|
||
REL relocation. */
|
||
bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
|
||
unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
|
||
const char *msg;
|
||
|
||
/* Find the relocation howto for this relocation. */
|
||
if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64. In particular, people use
|
||
64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
|
||
lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
|
||
space. Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
|
||
usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
|
||
stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits. */
|
||
howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
|
||
|
||
/* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
|
||
of the reloc. */
|
||
if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
|
||
rel->r_offset += 4;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
/* NewABI defaults to RELA relocations. */
|
||
howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type,
|
||
NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
|
||
&& (MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P
|
||
(input_bfd, input_section,
|
||
rel - relocs)));
|
||
|
||
if (!use_saved_addend_p)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
|
||
|
||
/* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
|
||
we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
|
||
relocated. Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
|
||
RELA relocation. To determine which flavor or relocation
|
||
this is, we depend on the fact that the INPUT_SECTION's
|
||
REL_HDR is read before its REL_HDR2. */
|
||
rel_hdr = &elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr;
|
||
if ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
|
||
>= (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel))
|
||
rel_hdr = elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr2;
|
||
if (rel_hdr->sh_entsize == MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (input_bfd))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Note that this is a REL relocation. */
|
||
rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file. */
|
||
addend = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, input_bfd,
|
||
contents);
|
||
addend &= howto->src_mask;
|
||
|
||
/* For some kinds of relocations, the ADDEND is a
|
||
combination of the addend stored in two different
|
||
relocations. */
|
||
if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
|
||
|| r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16
|
||
|| (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
|
||
&& mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
|
||
local_sections, FALSE)))
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_vma l;
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
|
||
reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
|
||
unsigned int lo;
|
||
|
||
/* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend,
|
||
left-shifted by sixteen bits, and the LO16
|
||
addend, sign extended. (Usually, the code does
|
||
a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of
|
||
the LO16 value.)
|
||
|
||
Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation. */
|
||
if (r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16)
|
||
lo = R_MIPS_GNU_REL_LO16;
|
||
else
|
||
lo = R_MIPS_LO16;
|
||
lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (input_bfd, lo,
|
||
rel, relend);
|
||
if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Obtain the addend kept there. */
|
||
lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, lo, FALSE);
|
||
l = mips_elf_obtain_contents (lo16_howto, lo16_relocation,
|
||
input_bfd, contents);
|
||
l &= lo16_howto->src_mask;
|
||
l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
|
||
l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
|
||
|
||
addend <<= 16;
|
||
|
||
/* Compute the combined addend. */
|
||
addend += l;
|
||
|
||
/* If PC-relative, subtract the difference between the
|
||
address of the LO part of the reloc and the address of
|
||
the HI part. The relocation is relative to the LO
|
||
part, but mips_elf_calculate_relocation() doesn't
|
||
know its address or the difference from the HI part, so
|
||
we subtract that difference here. See also the
|
||
comment in mips_elf_calculate_relocation(). */
|
||
if (r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16)
|
||
addend -= (lo16_relocation->r_offset - rel->r_offset);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* The addend is scrambled in the object file. See
|
||
mips_elf_perform_relocation for details on the
|
||
format. */
|
||
addend = (((addend & 0x1f0000) >> 5)
|
||
| ((addend & 0x7e00000) >> 16)
|
||
| (addend & 0x1f));
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
addend <<= howto->rightshift;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
addend = rel->r_addend;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (info->relocatable)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
|
||
unsigned long r_symndx;
|
||
|
||
if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
|
||
&& bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
|
||
rel->r_offset -= 4;
|
||
|
||
/* Since we're just relocating, all we need to do is copy
|
||
the relocations back out to the object file, unless
|
||
they're against a section symbol, in which case we need
|
||
to adjust by the section offset, or unless they're GP
|
||
relative in which case we need to adjust by the amount
|
||
that we're adjusting GP in this relocatable object. */
|
||
|
||
if (! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections,
|
||
FALSE))
|
||
/* There's nothing to do for non-local relocations. */
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL
|
||
|| r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL16
|
||
|| r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
|
||
|| r_type == R_MIPS_LITERAL)
|
||
addend -= (_bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
|
||
- _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd));
|
||
|
||
r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
|
||
sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
|
||
if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
|
||
/* Adjust the addend appropriately. */
|
||
addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
|
||
|
||
if (rela_relocation_p)
|
||
/* If this is a RELA relocation, just update the addend. */
|
||
rel->r_addend = addend;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
|
||
|| r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
|
||
|| r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16)
|
||
addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
|
||
else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
|
||
addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
|
||
else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
|
||
addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
|
||
else
|
||
addend >>= howto->rightshift;
|
||
|
||
/* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
|
||
mask because the place to which we are writing will be
|
||
source of the addend in the final link. */
|
||
addend &= howto->src_mask;
|
||
|
||
if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
|
||
/* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
|
||
ABI. Here, we need to update the addend. It would be
|
||
possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
|
||
but for endianness. */
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_vma sign_bits;
|
||
bfd_vma low_bits;
|
||
bfd_vma high_bits;
|
||
|
||
if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
|
||
#ifdef BFD64
|
||
sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
|
||
#else
|
||
sign_bits = -1;
|
||
#endif
|
||
else
|
||
sign_bits = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
|
||
do two separate stores. */
|
||
if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
|
||
first. */
|
||
low_bits = sign_bits;
|
||
high_bits = addend;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
low_bits = addend;
|
||
high_bits = sign_bits;
|
||
}
|
||
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
|
||
contents + rel->r_offset);
|
||
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
|
||
contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
|
||
input_bfd, input_section,
|
||
contents, FALSE))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Go on to the next relocation. */
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
|
||
relocations for the same offset. In that case we are
|
||
supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
|
||
for the next. */
|
||
if (rel + 1 < relend
|
||
&& rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
|
||
&& ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
|
||
use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
|
||
else
|
||
use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate. */
|
||
switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
|
||
input_section, info, rel,
|
||
addend, howto, local_syms,
|
||
local_sections, &value,
|
||
&name, &require_jalx,
|
||
use_saved_addend_p))
|
||
{
|
||
case bfd_reloc_continue:
|
||
/* There's nothing to do. */
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_reloc_undefined:
|
||
/* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
|
||
undefined_symbol callback. There's no real point in
|
||
trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
|
||
just skip ahead to the next relocation. */
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
|
||
msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
|
||
info->callbacks->warning
|
||
(info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_reloc_overflow:
|
||
if (use_saved_addend_p)
|
||
/* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
|
||
a given location. */
|
||
;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
|
||
if (! ((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
|
||
(info, name, howto->name, 0,
|
||
input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_reloc_ok:
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
|
||
until we reach the last one. */
|
||
if (use_saved_addend_p)
|
||
{
|
||
addend = value;
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
|
||
/* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
|
||
ABI. Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
|
||
that calculated the right value. Now, however, we
|
||
sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
|
||
64-bit value. We are especially generous here in that we
|
||
go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
|
||
only a 32-bit VMA. */
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_vma sign_bits;
|
||
bfd_vma low_bits;
|
||
bfd_vma high_bits;
|
||
|
||
if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
|
||
#ifdef BFD64
|
||
sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
|
||
#else
|
||
sign_bits = -1;
|
||
#endif
|
||
else
|
||
sign_bits = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
|
||
do two separate stores. */
|
||
if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Undo what we did above. */
|
||
rel->r_offset -= 4;
|
||
/* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
|
||
first. */
|
||
low_bits = sign_bits;
|
||
high_bits = value;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
low_bits = value;
|
||
high_bits = sign_bits;
|
||
}
|
||
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
|
||
contents + rel->r_offset);
|
||
bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
|
||
contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Actually perform the relocation. */
|
||
if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
|
||
input_bfd, input_section,
|
||
contents, require_jalx))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
|
||
adjust it appropriately now. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
||
const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
|
||
{
|
||
/* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
|
||
these, but we must place them into the right sections. */
|
||
static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
|
||
"_ftext",
|
||
"_etext",
|
||
"__dso_displacement",
|
||
"__elf_header",
|
||
"__program_header_table",
|
||
NULL
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
|
||
"_fdata",
|
||
"_edata",
|
||
"_end",
|
||
"_fbss",
|
||
NULL
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
const char* const *p;
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
|
||
for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
|
||
*p;
|
||
++p)
|
||
if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
|
||
IRIX6 linker. */
|
||
sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
|
||
sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
|
||
|
||
/* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections. */
|
||
if (i == 0)
|
||
sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
|
||
else
|
||
sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
|
||
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
|
||
dynamic sections here. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
|
||
Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd *dynobj;
|
||
bfd_vma gval;
|
||
asection *sgot;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
|
||
const char *name;
|
||
|
||
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
||
gval = sym->st_value;
|
||
|
||
if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *s;
|
||
bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE];
|
||
|
||
/* This symbol has a stub. Set it up. */
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
|
||
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
|
||
MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* FIXME: Can h->dynindex be more than 64K? */
|
||
if (h->dynindx & 0xffff0000)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Fill the stub. */
|
||
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub);
|
||
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE (output_bfd), stub + 4);
|
||
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + 8);
|
||
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16 (output_bfd) + h->dynindx, stub + 12);
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= s->_raw_size);
|
||
memcpy (s->contents + h->plt.offset, stub, MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE);
|
||
|
||
/* Mark the symbol as undefined. plt.offset != -1 occurs
|
||
only for the referenced symbol. */
|
||
sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
|
||
|
||
/* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
|
||
to reset the global offset table entry for this external
|
||
to its stub address when unlinking a shared object. */
|
||
gval = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset + h->plt.offset;
|
||
sym->st_value = gval;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
|
||
|| (h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_FORCED_LOCAL) != 0);
|
||
|
||
sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
|
||
g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
|
||
the symbols that need them. */
|
||
if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
|
||
&& h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_vma offset;
|
||
bfd_vma value;
|
||
|
||
value = sym->st_value;
|
||
offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h);
|
||
MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (g->next && h->dynindx != -1)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
|
||
bfd_vma entry;
|
||
bfd_vma offset;
|
||
|
||
gg = g;
|
||
|
||
e.abfd = output_bfd;
|
||
e.symndx = -1;
|
||
e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
|
||
|
||
for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
|
||
{
|
||
if (g->got_entries
|
||
&& (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
|
||
&e)))
|
||
{
|
||
offset = p->gotidx;
|
||
if (info->shared
|
||
|| (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
|
||
&& p->d.h != NULL
|
||
&& ((p->d.h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0)
|
||
&& ((p->d.h->root.elf_link_hash_flags
|
||
& ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry. Due to
|
||
the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
|
||
up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
|
||
mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
|
||
appropriate addend. */
|
||
Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
|
||
|
||
memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
|
||
if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
|
||
rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
|
||
else
|
||
rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
|
||
rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
|
||
|
||
entry = 0;
|
||
if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
|
||
(output_bfd, info, rel,
|
||
e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
entry = sym->st_value;
|
||
MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */
|
||
name = h->root.root.string;
|
||
if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
|
||
sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
|
||
sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
|
||
sym->st_value = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
|
||
{
|
||
sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
|
||
sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
|
||
sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
|
||
{
|
||
if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
|
||
sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
|
||
sym->st_value = 0;
|
||
sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
|
||
sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
|
||
sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
|
||
sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
|
||
{
|
||
if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
|
||
sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
|
||
else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
|
||
sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols. */
|
||
if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
|
||
mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
|
||
|
||
if (! info->shared)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
|
||
&& (strcmp (name, "__rld_map") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (name, "__RLD_MAP") == 0))
|
||
{
|
||
asection *s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map");
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
||
sym->st_value = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
|
||
bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, s->contents);
|
||
if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value == 0)
|
||
mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
|
||
&& strcmp (name, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* IRIX6 does not use a .rld_map section. */
|
||
if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5
|
||
|| IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_none)
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map")
|
||
!= NULL);
|
||
mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even. */
|
||
if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16
|
||
&& (sym->st_value & 1) != 0)
|
||
--sym->st_value;
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd *dynobj;
|
||
asection *sdyn;
|
||
asection *sgot;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
|
||
|
||
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
||
|
||
sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
|
||
|
||
sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
|
||
if (sgot == NULL)
|
||
gg = g = NULL;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
|
||
gg = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
|
||
g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, output_bfd);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_byte *b;
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
|
||
|
||
for (b = sdyn->contents;
|
||
b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->_raw_size;
|
||
b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
|
||
const char *name;
|
||
size_t elemsize;
|
||
asection *s;
|
||
bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
|
||
|
||
/* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
|
||
(*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
|
||
|
||
/* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
|
||
swap_out_p = TRUE;
|
||
|
||
switch (dyn.d_tag)
|
||
{
|
||
case DT_RELENT:
|
||
s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_STRSZ:
|
||
/* Rewrite DT_STRSZ. */
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_val =
|
||
_bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_PLTGOT:
|
||
name = ".got";
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
|
||
time ((time_t *) &dyn.d_un.d_val);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
|
||
/* XXX FIXME: */
|
||
swap_out_p = FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
|
||
/* XXX FIXME: */
|
||
swap_out_p = FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
|
||
s = output_bfd->sections;
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
|
||
/* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
|
||
entry of the first external symbol that is not
|
||
referenced within the same object. */
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
|
||
if (gg->global_gotsym)
|
||
{
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_val = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
/* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
|
||
to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
|
||
DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, so we just fall through. */
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
|
||
name = ".dynsym";
|
||
elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
|
||
|
||
if (s->_cooked_size != 0)
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_val = s->_cooked_size / elemsize;
|
||
else
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_val = s->_raw_size / elemsize;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_ptr = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
|
||
s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
|
||
(output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DT_RELSZ:
|
||
/* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
|
||
decided not to make. This is for the n64 irix rld,
|
||
which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
|
||
are trailing null entries. */
|
||
s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
|
||
dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
|
||
* (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
|
||
? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
|
||
: sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
swap_out_p = FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (swap_out_p)
|
||
(*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
|
||
(dynobj, &dyn, b);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
|
||
runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
|
||
This isn't the case of IRIX rld. */
|
||
if (sgot != NULL && sgot->_raw_size > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents);
|
||
MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000,
|
||
sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (sgot != NULL)
|
||
elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
|
||
= MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
|
||
|
||
/* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots. */
|
||
if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
|
||
bfd_vma addend = 0;
|
||
|
||
memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
|
||
rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
|
||
|
||
for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_vma index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno;
|
||
|
||
MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
|
||
+ index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
|
||
MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000, sgot->contents
|
||
+ index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
|
||
|
||
if (! info->shared)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
while (index < g->assigned_gotno)
|
||
{
|
||
rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
|
||
= index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
|
||
if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
|
||
(output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
|
||
bfd_abs_section_ptr,
|
||
0, &addend, sgot)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
{
|
||
asection *s;
|
||
Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
|
||
|
||
if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Write .compact_rel section out. */
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
|
||
if (s != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
cpt.id1 = 1;
|
||
cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
|
||
cpt.id2 = 2;
|
||
cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
|
||
+ sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
|
||
cpt.reserved0 = 0;
|
||
cpt.reserved1 = 0;
|
||
bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
|
||
((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
|
||
s->contents));
|
||
|
||
/* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text. */
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
|
||
MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
|
||
if (s != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
file_ptr dummy_offset;
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (s->_raw_size >= MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE);
|
||
dummy_offset = s->_raw_size - MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE;
|
||
memset (s->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
|
||
MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We need to sort the entries of the dynamic relocation section. */
|
||
|
||
s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
|
||
|
||
if (s != NULL
|
||
&& s->_raw_size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
|
||
{
|
||
reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
|
||
|
||
if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
|
||
qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1, s->reloc_count - 1,
|
||
sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel), sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
|
||
else
|
||
qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1, s->reloc_count - 1,
|
||
sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel), sort_dynamic_relocs);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
|
||
{
|
||
flagword val;
|
||
|
||
switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
|
||
{
|
||
default:
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips3000:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips3900:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips6000:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips4000:
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips4300:
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips4400:
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips4600:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips4010:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips4100:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips4111:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips4120:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips4650:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips5400:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips5500:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips9000:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_9000;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips5000:
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips7000:
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips8000:
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips10000:
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips12000:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips5:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips_octeon:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
|
||
val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
|
||
elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
|
||
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
|
||
file. This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
|
||
number. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
|
||
bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int i;
|
||
Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
|
||
const char *name;
|
||
asection *sec;
|
||
|
||
/* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
|
||
is nonzero. This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
|
||
a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH. */
|
||
if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
|
||
mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
|
||
|
||
/* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
|
||
info for each special section. */
|
||
for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
|
||
i < elf_numsections (abfd);
|
||
i++, hdrpp++)
|
||
{
|
||
switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
|
||
{
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
|
||
sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
|
||
if (sec != NULL)
|
||
(*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
|
||
BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
|
||
name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
|
||
&& strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0);
|
||
sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
|
||
(*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
|
||
BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
|
||
name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
|
||
&& strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content",
|
||
sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1) == 0);
|
||
sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
|
||
name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
|
||
(*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
|
||
sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
|
||
if (sec != NULL)
|
||
(*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
|
||
sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
|
||
if (sec != NULL)
|
||
(*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
|
||
BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
|
||
name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
|
||
if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) == 0)
|
||
sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
|
||
name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel",
|
||
sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) == 0);
|
||
sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
|
||
(name
|
||
+ sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
|
||
}
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
|
||
(*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
|
||
segments. */
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *s;
|
||
int ret = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment. */
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
|
||
if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
|
||
++ret;
|
||
|
||
/* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment. */
|
||
if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
|
||
&& bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
|
||
MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
|
||
++ret;
|
||
|
||
/* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment. */
|
||
if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
|
||
&& bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
|
||
&& bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
|
||
++ret;
|
||
|
||
return ret;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *s;
|
||
struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
|
||
bfd_size_type amt;
|
||
|
||
/* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
|
||
segment. */
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
|
||
if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
|
||
if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
|
||
break;
|
||
if (m == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
amt = sizeof *m;
|
||
m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (m == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
|
||
m->count = 1;
|
||
m->sections[0] = s;
|
||
|
||
/* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
|
||
pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
|
||
while (*pm != NULL
|
||
&& ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
|
||
|| (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
|
||
pm = &(*pm)->next;
|
||
|
||
m->next = *pm;
|
||
*pm = m;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
|
||
.dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC. However, we do have to insert a
|
||
PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
|
||
table. */
|
||
if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
|
||
/* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
|
||
for this section, so don't create another. I'm not sure this
|
||
is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
|
||
now. */
|
||
&& IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
|
||
{
|
||
for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
|
||
if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (s)
|
||
{
|
||
struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
|
||
|
||
pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
|
||
while (*pm != NULL
|
||
&& ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
|
||
|| (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
|
||
pm = &(*pm)->next;
|
||
|
||
amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
|
||
options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
options_segment->next = *pm;
|
||
options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
|
||
options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
|
||
options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
|
||
options_segment->count = 1;
|
||
options_segment->sections[0] = s;
|
||
*pm = options_segment;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
|
||
for the RTPROC header. FIXME: Rewrite without section names. */
|
||
if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
|
||
&& bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
|
||
&& bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
|
||
if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
|
||
break;
|
||
if (m == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
amt = sizeof *m;
|
||
m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (m == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
|
||
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
|
||
if (s == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
m->count = 0;
|
||
m->p_flags = 0;
|
||
m->p_flags_valid = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
m->count = 1;
|
||
m->sections[0] = s;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment. */
|
||
pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
|
||
while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
|
||
pm = &(*pm)->next;
|
||
if (*pm != NULL)
|
||
pm = &(*pm)->next;
|
||
|
||
m->next = *pm;
|
||
*pm = m;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
/* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
|
||
.dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
|
||
between. */
|
||
for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL;
|
||
pm = &(*pm)->next)
|
||
if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
|
||
break;
|
||
m = *pm;
|
||
if (m != NULL && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
|
||
{
|
||
/* For a normal mips executable the permissions for the PT_DYNAMIC
|
||
segment are read, write and execute. We do that here since
|
||
the code in elf.c sets only the read permission. This matters
|
||
sometimes for the dynamic linker. */
|
||
if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_W | PF_X;
|
||
m->p_flags_valid = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
if (m != NULL
|
||
&& m->count == 1 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
static const char *sec_names[] =
|
||
{
|
||
".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
|
||
};
|
||
bfd_vma low, high;
|
||
unsigned int i, c;
|
||
struct elf_segment_map *n;
|
||
|
||
low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
|
||
high = 0;
|
||
for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
|
||
if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_size_type sz;
|
||
|
||
if (low > s->vma)
|
||
low = s->vma;
|
||
sz = s->_cooked_size;
|
||
if (sz == 0)
|
||
sz = s->_raw_size;
|
||
if (high < s->vma + sz)
|
||
high = s->vma + sz;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
c = 0;
|
||
for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
|
||
if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
|
||
&& s->vma >= low
|
||
&& ((s->vma
|
||
+ (s->_cooked_size !=
|
||
0 ? s->_cooked_size : s->_raw_size)) <= high))
|
||
++c;
|
||
|
||
amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
|
||
n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (n == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
*n = *m;
|
||
n->count = c;
|
||
|
||
i = 0;
|
||
for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
|
||
{
|
||
if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
|
||
&& s->vma >= low
|
||
&& ((s->vma
|
||
+ (s->_cooked_size != 0 ?
|
||
s->_cooked_size : s->_raw_size)) <= high))
|
||
{
|
||
n->sections[i] = s;
|
||
++i;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
*pm = n;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
|
||
relocation. */
|
||
|
||
asection *
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
||
Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
|
||
Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
|
||
{
|
||
/* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special? */
|
||
|
||
if (h != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
|
||
{
|
||
case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
switch (h->root.type)
|
||
{
|
||
case bfd_link_hash_defined:
|
||
case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
|
||
return h->root.u.def.section;
|
||
|
||
case bfd_link_hash_common:
|
||
return h->root.u.c.p->section;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
return bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
|
||
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
||
asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
#if 0
|
||
Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
|
||
bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
|
||
const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
|
||
unsigned long r_symndx;
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
||
|
||
symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
|
||
sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
|
||
local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
|
||
|
||
relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
|
||
for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
|
||
switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info))
|
||
{
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
|
||
case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
|
||
/* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort
|
||
of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries,
|
||
so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time. */
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
|
||
hiding the old indirect symbol. Process additional relocation
|
||
information. Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
|
||
_bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (const struct elf_backend_data *bed,
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
|
||
|
||
_bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (bed, dir, ind);
|
||
|
||
if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
|
||
indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
|
||
dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
|
||
if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
|
||
dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
|
||
if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
|
||
dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
|
||
struct elf_link_hash_entry *entry,
|
||
bfd_boolean force_local)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd *dynobj;
|
||
asection *got;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
||
|
||
h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
|
||
if (h->forced_local)
|
||
return;
|
||
h->forced_local = force_local;
|
||
|
||
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
||
if (dynobj != NULL && force_local)
|
||
{
|
||
got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
|
||
g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info;
|
||
|
||
if (g->next)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_got_entry e;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *gg = g;
|
||
|
||
/* Since we're turning what used to be a global symbol into a
|
||
local one, bump up the number of local entries of each GOT
|
||
that had an entry for it. This will automatically decrease
|
||
the number of global entries, since global_gotno is actually
|
||
the upper limit of global entries. */
|
||
e.abfd = dynobj;
|
||
e.symndx = -1;
|
||
e.d.h = h;
|
||
|
||
for (g = g->next; g != gg; g = g->next)
|
||
if (htab_find (g->got_entries, &e))
|
||
{
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
|
||
g->local_gotno++;
|
||
g->global_gotno--;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this was a global symbol forced into the primary GOT, we
|
||
no longer need an entry for it. We can't release the entry
|
||
at this point, but we must at least stop counting it as one
|
||
of the symbols that required a forced got entry. */
|
||
if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
|
||
{
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (gg->assigned_gotno > 0);
|
||
gg->assigned_gotno--;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if (g->global_gotno == 0 && g->global_gotsym == NULL)
|
||
/* If we haven't got through GOT allocation yet, just bump up the
|
||
number of local entries, as this symbol won't be counted as
|
||
global. */
|
||
g->local_gotno++;
|
||
else if (h->root.got.offset == 1)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If we're past non-multi-GOT allocation and this symbol had
|
||
been marked for a global got entry, give it a local entry
|
||
instead. */
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
|
||
g->local_gotno++;
|
||
g->global_gotno--;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
_bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->root, force_local);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#define PDR_SIZE 32
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *o;
|
||
bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
|
||
unsigned char *tdata;
|
||
size_t i, skip;
|
||
|
||
o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
|
||
if (! o)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
if (o->_raw_size == 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
if (o->_raw_size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
if (o->output_section != NULL
|
||
&& bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->_raw_size / PDR_SIZE);
|
||
if (! tdata)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
|
||
info->keep_memory);
|
||
if (!cookie->rels)
|
||
{
|
||
free (tdata);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
|
||
cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->_raw_size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
|
||
{
|
||
if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
|
||
{
|
||
tdata[i] = 1;
|
||
skip ++;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (skip != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
|
||
o->_cooked_size = o->_raw_size - skip * PDR_SIZE;
|
||
ret = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
free (tdata);
|
||
|
||
if (! info->keep_memory)
|
||
free (cookie->rels);
|
||
|
||
return ret;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
|
||
{
|
||
if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd, asection *sec,
|
||
bfd_byte *contents)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
to = contents;
|
||
end = contents + sec->_raw_size;
|
||
for (from = contents, i = 0;
|
||
from < end;
|
||
from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
|
||
{
|
||
if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
|
||
continue;
|
||
if (to != from)
|
||
memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
|
||
to += PDR_SIZE;
|
||
}
|
||
bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
|
||
sec->output_offset, sec->_cooked_size);
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
|
||
handle the ECOFF debugging information. */
|
||
|
||
struct mips_elf_find_line
|
||
{
|
||
struct ecoff_debug_info d;
|
||
struct ecoff_find_line i;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
|
||
asymbol **symbols, bfd_vma offset,
|
||
const char **filename_ptr,
|
||
const char **functionname_ptr,
|
||
unsigned int *line_ptr)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *msec;
|
||
|
||
if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
|
||
filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
|
||
line_ptr))
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
|
||
filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
|
||
line_ptr, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0,
|
||
&elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
|
||
if (msec != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
flagword origflags;
|
||
struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
|
||
const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
|
||
get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
|
||
|
||
/* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
|
||
cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field. We force it back on here
|
||
if appropriate (which it normally will be). */
|
||
origflags = msec->flags;
|
||
if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
|
||
msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
|
||
|
||
fi = elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
|
||
if (fi == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
|
||
char *fraw_src;
|
||
char *fraw_end;
|
||
struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
|
||
bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
|
||
|
||
fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (fi == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
msec->flags = origflags;
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
|
||
{
|
||
msec->flags = origflags;
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Swap in the FDR information. */
|
||
amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
|
||
fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
msec->flags = origflags;
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
|
||
fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
|
||
fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
|
||
fraw_end = (fraw_src
|
||
+ fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
|
||
for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
|
||
(*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
|
||
|
||
elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
|
||
|
||
/* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
|
||
find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
|
||
objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
|
||
rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
|
||
wasted is unimportant. Still, it would probably be a
|
||
good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away. */
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
|
||
&fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
|
||
line_ptr))
|
||
{
|
||
msec->flags = origflags;
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
msec->flags = origflags;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine. */
|
||
|
||
return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
|
||
filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
|
||
line_ptr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
|
||
remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
|
||
GP value in the section_processing routine. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
|
||
const void *location,
|
||
file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
|
||
{
|
||
if (strcmp (section->name, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_byte *c;
|
||
|
||
if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
|
||
section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
|
||
if (c == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_size_type size;
|
||
|
||
if (section->_cooked_size != 0)
|
||
size = section->_cooked_size;
|
||
else
|
||
size = section->_raw_size;
|
||
c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
|
||
if (c == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
|
||
count);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
|
||
MIPS relocations need to be handled specially. Sigh. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_byte *
|
||
_bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
|
||
(bfd *abfd,
|
||
struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
|
||
struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
|
||
bfd_byte *data,
|
||
bfd_boolean relocatable,
|
||
asymbol **symbols)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
|
||
bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
|
||
asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
|
||
|
||
long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
|
||
arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
|
||
long reloc_count;
|
||
|
||
if (reloc_size < 0)
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
|
||
if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
/* read in the section */
|
||
if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0,
|
||
input_section->_raw_size))
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
/* We're not relaxing the section, so just copy the size info */
|
||
input_section->_cooked_size = input_section->_raw_size;
|
||
input_section->reloc_done = TRUE;
|
||
|
||
reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
|
||
input_section,
|
||
reloc_vector,
|
||
symbols);
|
||
if (reloc_count < 0)
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
|
||
if (reloc_count > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
arelent **parent;
|
||
/* for mips */
|
||
int gp_found;
|
||
bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678; /* initialize just to shut gcc up */
|
||
|
||
{
|
||
struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
|
||
struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
|
||
/* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats. */
|
||
if (abfd && input_bfd
|
||
&& abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
|
||
lh = 0;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
|
||
lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
|
||
}
|
||
lookup:
|
||
if (lh)
|
||
{
|
||
switch (lh->type)
|
||
{
|
||
case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
|
||
case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
|
||
case bfd_link_hash_common:
|
||
gp_found = 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
case bfd_link_hash_defined:
|
||
case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
|
||
gp_found = 1;
|
||
gp = lh->u.def.value;
|
||
break;
|
||
case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
|
||
case bfd_link_hash_warning:
|
||
lh = lh->u.i.link;
|
||
/* @@FIXME ignoring warning for now */
|
||
goto lookup;
|
||
case bfd_link_hash_new:
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
gp_found = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
/* end mips */
|
||
for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
|
||
{
|
||
char *error_message = NULL;
|
||
bfd_reloc_status_type r;
|
||
|
||
/* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
|
||
knowing the gp of the output bfd. */
|
||
asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
|
||
if (bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section) && abfd)
|
||
{
|
||
/* The special_function wouldn't get called anyway. */
|
||
}
|
||
else if (!gp_found)
|
||
{
|
||
/* The gp isn't there; let the special function code
|
||
fall over on its own. */
|
||
}
|
||
else if ((*parent)->howto->special_function
|
||
== _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
|
||
{
|
||
/* bypass special_function call */
|
||
r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
|
||
input_section, relocatable,
|
||
data, gp);
|
||
goto skip_bfd_perform_relocation;
|
||
}
|
||
/* end mips specific stuff */
|
||
|
||
r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data, input_section,
|
||
relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
|
||
&error_message);
|
||
skip_bfd_perform_relocation:
|
||
|
||
if (relocatable)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *os = input_section->output_section;
|
||
|
||
/* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
|
||
os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
|
||
os->reloc_count++;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
|
||
{
|
||
switch (r)
|
||
{
|
||
case bfd_reloc_undefined:
|
||
if (!((*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
|
||
(link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
|
||
input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address,
|
||
TRUE)))
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
break;
|
||
case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
|
||
if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
|
||
(link_info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
|
||
(*parent)->address)))
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
break;
|
||
case bfd_reloc_overflow:
|
||
if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
|
||
(link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
|
||
(*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
|
||
input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address)))
|
||
goto error_return;
|
||
break;
|
||
case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
if (reloc_vector != NULL)
|
||
free (reloc_vector);
|
||
return data;
|
||
|
||
error_return:
|
||
if (reloc_vector != NULL)
|
||
free (reloc_vector);
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
|
||
|
||
struct bfd_link_hash_table *
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
|
||
{
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
|
||
bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
|
||
|
||
ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
|
||
if (ret == NULL)
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
|
||
if (! _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
|
||
mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc))
|
||
{
|
||
free (ret);
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* We no longer use this. */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES; i++)
|
||
ret->dynsym_sec_strindex[i] = (bfd_size_type) -1;
|
||
#endif
|
||
ret->procedure_count = 0;
|
||
ret->compact_rel_size = 0;
|
||
ret->use_rld_obj_head = FALSE;
|
||
ret->rld_value = 0;
|
||
ret->mips16_stubs_seen = FALSE;
|
||
|
||
return &ret->root.root;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
|
||
the .mdebug sections. We need to merge all instances of these
|
||
sections together, not write them all out sequentially. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
|
||
{
|
||
asection **secpp;
|
||
asection *o;
|
||
struct bfd_link_order *p;
|
||
asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
|
||
asection *rtproc_sec;
|
||
Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
|
||
struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
|
||
const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap
|
||
= get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
|
||
HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
|
||
void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
|
||
asection *s;
|
||
EXTR esym;
|
||
unsigned int i;
|
||
bfd_size_type amt;
|
||
|
||
static const char * const secname[] =
|
||
{
|
||
".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
|
||
".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
|
||
};
|
||
static const int sc[] =
|
||
{
|
||
scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
|
||
scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* We'd carefully arranged the dynamic symbol indices, and then the
|
||
generic size_dynamic_sections renumbered them out from under us.
|
||
Rather than trying somehow to prevent the renumbering, just do
|
||
the sort again. */
|
||
if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd *dynobj;
|
||
asection *got;
|
||
struct mips_got_info *g;
|
||
|
||
/* When we resort, we must tell mips_elf_sort_hash_table what
|
||
the lowest index it may use is. That's the number of section
|
||
symbols we're going to add. The generic ELF linker only
|
||
adds these symbols when building a shared object. Note that
|
||
we count the sections after (possibly) removing the .options
|
||
section above. */
|
||
if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, (info->shared
|
||
? bfd_count_sections (abfd) + 1
|
||
: 1)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Make sure we didn't grow the global .got region. */
|
||
dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
|
||
got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
|
||
g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info;
|
||
|
||
if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
|
||
BFD_ASSERT ((elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
|
||
- g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
|
||
<= g->global_gotno);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* We want to set the GP value for ld -r. */
|
||
/* On IRIX5, we omit the .options section. On IRIX6, however, we
|
||
include it, even though we don't process it quite right. (Some
|
||
entries are supposed to be merged.) Empirically, we seem to be
|
||
better off including it then not. */
|
||
if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
|
||
for (secpp = &abfd->sections; *secpp != NULL; secpp = &(*secpp)->next)
|
||
{
|
||
if (strcmp ((*secpp)->name, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
for (p = (*secpp)->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next)
|
||
if (p->type == bfd_indirect_link_order)
|
||
p->u.indirect.section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
|
||
(*secpp)->link_order_head = NULL;
|
||
bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, secpp);
|
||
--abfd->section_count;
|
||
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We include .MIPS.options, even though we don't process it quite right.
|
||
(Some entries are supposed to be merged.) At IRIX6 empirically we seem
|
||
to be better off including it than not. */
|
||
for (secpp = &abfd->sections; *secpp != NULL; secpp = &(*secpp)->next)
|
||
{
|
||
if (strcmp ((*secpp)->name, ".MIPS.options") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
for (p = (*secpp)->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next)
|
||
if (p->type == bfd_indirect_link_order)
|
||
p->u.indirect.section->flags &=~ SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
|
||
(*secpp)->link_order_head = NULL;
|
||
bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, secpp);
|
||
--abfd->section_count;
|
||
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Get a value for the GP register. */
|
||
if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
|
||
|
||
h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
|
||
if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
|
||
elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
|
||
+ h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
|
||
+ h->u.def.section->output_offset);
|
||
else if (info->relocatable)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
|
||
|
||
/* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset. */
|
||
for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
|
||
if (o->vma < lo
|
||
&& (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
|
||
lo = o->vma;
|
||
|
||
/* And calculate GP relative to that. */
|
||
elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (abfd);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
|
||
involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
|
||
callback to warn that GP is not defined. */
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
|
||
information. */
|
||
reginfo_sec = NULL;
|
||
mdebug_sec = NULL;
|
||
gptab_data_sec = NULL;
|
||
gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
|
||
for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
|
||
{
|
||
if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
memset (®info, 0, sizeof reginfo);
|
||
|
||
/* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
|
||
Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
|
||
the information together. */
|
||
for (p = o->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *input_section;
|
||
bfd *input_bfd;
|
||
Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
|
||
Elf32_RegInfo sub;
|
||
|
||
if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
|
||
{
|
||
if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
|
||
continue;
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
|
||
input_bfd = input_section->owner;
|
||
|
||
/* The linker emulation code has probably clobbered the
|
||
size to be zero bytes. */
|
||
if (input_section->_raw_size == 0)
|
||
input_section->_raw_size = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
|
||
|
||
if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
|
||
&ext, 0, sizeof ext))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
|
||
|
||
reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
|
||
reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
|
||
reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
|
||
reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
|
||
reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
|
||
|
||
/* ri_gp_value is set by the function
|
||
mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is
|
||
finally written out. */
|
||
|
||
/* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
|
||
elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
|
||
input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
|
||
BFD_ASSERT(o->_raw_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
|
||
|
||
/* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
|
||
matters, but someday it might). */
|
||
o->link_order_head = NULL;
|
||
|
||
reginfo_sec = o;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
struct extsym_info einfo;
|
||
bfd_vma last;
|
||
|
||
/* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
|
||
Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
|
||
the information together. */
|
||
symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
|
||
/* FIXME: What should the version stamp be? */
|
||
symhdr->vstamp = 0;
|
||
symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
|
||
symhdr->cbLine = 0;
|
||
symhdr->idnMax = 0;
|
||
symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
|
||
symhdr->isymMax = 0;
|
||
symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
|
||
symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
|
||
symhdr->issMax = 0;
|
||
symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
|
||
symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
|
||
symhdr->crfd = 0;
|
||
symhdr->iextMax = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
|
||
debug_info structure. */
|
||
debug.line = NULL;
|
||
debug.external_dnr = NULL;
|
||
debug.external_pdr = NULL;
|
||
debug.external_sym = NULL;
|
||
debug.external_opt = NULL;
|
||
debug.external_aux = NULL;
|
||
debug.ss = NULL;
|
||
debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
|
||
debug.external_fdr = NULL;
|
||
debug.external_rfd = NULL;
|
||
debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
|
||
|
||
mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
|
||
if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
esym.jmptbl = 0;
|
||
esym.cobol_main = 0;
|
||
esym.weakext = 0;
|
||
esym.reserved = 0;
|
||
esym.ifd = ifdNil;
|
||
esym.asym.iss = issNil;
|
||
esym.asym.st = stLocal;
|
||
esym.asym.reserved = 0;
|
||
esym.asym.index = indexNil;
|
||
last = 0;
|
||
for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
|
||
{
|
||
esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
|
||
s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
|
||
if (s != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
esym.asym.value = s->vma;
|
||
last = s->vma + s->_raw_size;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
esym.asym.value = last;
|
||
if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
|
||
secname[i], &esym))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
for (p = o->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *input_section;
|
||
bfd *input_bfd;
|
||
const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
|
||
struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
|
||
char *eraw_src;
|
||
char *eraw_end;
|
||
|
||
if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
|
||
{
|
||
if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
|
||
continue;
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
|
||
input_bfd = input_section->owner;
|
||
|
||
if (bfd_get_flavour (input_bfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
|
||
|| (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
|
||
->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap) == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
|
||
doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
|
||
want to deal with it. */
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
|
||
->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->_raw_size);
|
||
|
||
/* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
|
||
read in the debugging information and set up an
|
||
ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now. */
|
||
if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
|
||
&input_debug))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
|
||
(mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
|
||
&input_debug, input_swap, info)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Loop through the external symbols. For each one with
|
||
interesting information, try to find the symbol in
|
||
the linker global hash table and save the information
|
||
for the output external symbols. */
|
||
eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
|
||
eraw_end = (eraw_src
|
||
+ (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
|
||
* input_swap->external_ext_size));
|
||
for (;
|
||
eraw_src < eraw_end;
|
||
eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
|
||
{
|
||
EXTR ext;
|
||
const char *name;
|
||
struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
|
||
|
||
(*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
|
||
if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
|
||
|| ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
|
||
|| ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
|
||
h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
|
||
name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
|
||
if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
if (ext.ifd != -1)
|
||
{
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
|
||
< input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
|
||
ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
h->esym = ext;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Free up the information we just read. */
|
||
free (input_debug.line);
|
||
free (input_debug.external_dnr);
|
||
free (input_debug.external_pdr);
|
||
free (input_debug.external_sym);
|
||
free (input_debug.external_opt);
|
||
free (input_debug.external_aux);
|
||
free (input_debug.ss);
|
||
free (input_debug.ssext);
|
||
free (input_debug.external_fdr);
|
||
free (input_debug.external_rfd);
|
||
free (input_debug.external_ext);
|
||
|
||
/* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
|
||
elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
|
||
input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && info->shared)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Create .rtproc section. */
|
||
rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
|
||
if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
|
||
| SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
|
||
|
||
rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section (abfd, ".rtproc");
|
||
if (rtproc_sec == NULL
|
||
|| ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, rtproc_sec, flags)
|
||
|| ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
|
||
info, rtproc_sec,
|
||
&debug))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Build the external symbol information. */
|
||
einfo.abfd = abfd;
|
||
einfo.info = info;
|
||
einfo.debug = &debug;
|
||
einfo.swap = swap;
|
||
einfo.failed = FALSE;
|
||
mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
|
||
mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
|
||
if (einfo.failed)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Set the size of the .mdebug section. */
|
||
o->_raw_size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
|
||
|
||
/* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
|
||
matters, but someday it might). */
|
||
o->link_order_head = NULL;
|
||
|
||
mdebug_sec = o;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (strncmp (o->name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
const char *subname;
|
||
unsigned int c;
|
||
Elf32_gptab *tab;
|
||
Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
|
||
unsigned int j;
|
||
|
||
/* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
|
||
information describing how the small data area would
|
||
change depending upon the -G switch. These sections
|
||
not used in executables files. */
|
||
if (! info->relocatable)
|
||
{
|
||
for (p = o->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *input_section;
|
||
|
||
if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
|
||
{
|
||
if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
|
||
continue;
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
|
||
|
||
/* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
|
||
elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
|
||
input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
|
||
currently matters, but someday it might). */
|
||
o->link_order_head = NULL;
|
||
|
||
/* Really remove the section. */
|
||
for (secpp = &abfd->sections;
|
||
*secpp != o;
|
||
secpp = &(*secpp)->next)
|
||
;
|
||
bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, secpp);
|
||
--abfd->section_count;
|
||
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
|
||
uninitialized data. */
|
||
if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
|
||
gptab_data_sec = o;
|
||
else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
|
||
gptab_bss_sec = o;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
||
(_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"),
|
||
bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name);
|
||
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
|
||
.gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
|
||
.gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss. It is possible that there is
|
||
no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
|
||
case we must change the name of the output section. */
|
||
subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
|
||
if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
if (o == gptab_data_sec)
|
||
o->name = ".gptab.data";
|
||
else
|
||
o->name = ".gptab.bss";
|
||
subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Set up the first entry. */
|
||
c = 1;
|
||
amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
|
||
tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
|
||
if (tab == NULL)
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
|
||
tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Combine the input sections. */
|
||
for (p = o->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next)
|
||
{
|
||
asection *input_section;
|
||
bfd *input_bfd;
|
||
bfd_size_type size;
|
||
unsigned long last;
|
||
bfd_size_type gpentry;
|
||
|
||
if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
|
||
{
|
||
if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
|
||
continue;
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
|
||
input_bfd = input_section->owner;
|
||
|
||
/* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
|
||
by one. We know that the input gptab entries are
|
||
sorted by ascending -G value. */
|
||
size = bfd_section_size (input_bfd, input_section);
|
||
last = 0;
|
||
for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
|
||
gpentry < size;
|
||
gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
|
||
{
|
||
Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
|
||
Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
|
||
unsigned long val;
|
||
unsigned long add;
|
||
bfd_boolean exact;
|
||
unsigned int look;
|
||
|
||
if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
|
||
(input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
|
||
sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
|
||
{
|
||
free (tab);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
|
||
&int_gptab);
|
||
val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
|
||
add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
|
||
|
||
exact = FALSE;
|
||
for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
|
||
{
|
||
if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
|
||
tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
|
||
|
||
if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
|
||
exact = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (! exact)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
|
||
unsigned int max;
|
||
|
||
/* We need a new table entry. */
|
||
amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
|
||
new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
|
||
if (new_tab == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
free (tab);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
tab = new_tab;
|
||
tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
|
||
tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
|
||
|
||
/* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
|
||
value, since that will be implied by this new
|
||
value. */
|
||
max = 0;
|
||
for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
|
||
{
|
||
if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
|
||
&& (max == 0
|
||
|| (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
|
||
> tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
|
||
max = look;
|
||
}
|
||
if (max != 0)
|
||
tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
|
||
tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
|
||
|
||
++c;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
|
||
elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
|
||
input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The table must be sorted by -G value. */
|
||
if (c > 2)
|
||
qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
|
||
|
||
/* Swap out the table. */
|
||
amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
|
||
ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
|
||
if (ext_tab == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
free (tab);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
|
||
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
|
||
free (tab);
|
||
|
||
o->_raw_size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
|
||
o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
|
||
|
||
/* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
|
||
matters, but someday it might). */
|
||
o->link_order_head = NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */
|
||
if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
/* Now write out the computed sections. */
|
||
|
||
if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
|
||
|
||
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, ®info, &ext);
|
||
if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
|
||
if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
|
||
swap, info,
|
||
mdebug_sec->filepos))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
|
||
bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
|
||
gptab_data_sec->contents,
|
||
0, gptab_data_sec->_raw_size))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
|
||
gptab_bss_sec->contents,
|
||
0, gptab_bss_sec->_raw_size))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
|
||
{
|
||
rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
|
||
if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
|
||
rtproc_sec->contents,
|
||
0, rtproc_sec->_raw_size))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE. */
|
||
|
||
struct mips_mach_extension {
|
||
unsigned long extension, base;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another. The entries
|
||
are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last. */
|
||
|
||
static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] = {
|
||
/* MIPS64r2 extensions. */
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips_octeon, bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2 },
|
||
|
||
/* MIPS64 extensions. */
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
|
||
|
||
/* MIPS V extensions. */
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
|
||
|
||
/* R10000 extensions. */
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
|
||
|
||
/* R5000 extensions. Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
|
||
vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff. It seems
|
||
better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
|
||
many libraries will just use the core ISA. Perhaps we could add
|
||
some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem. */
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
|
||
|
||
/* MIPS IV extensions. */
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips9000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
|
||
|
||
/* VR4100 extensions. */
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
|
||
|
||
/* MIPS III extensions. */
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
|
||
|
||
/* MIPS32 extensions. */
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
|
||
|
||
/* MIPS II extensions. */
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
|
||
|
||
/* MIPS I extensions. */
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
|
||
{ bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
|
||
{
|
||
size_t i;
|
||
|
||
if (extension == base)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32
|
||
&& mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64, extension))
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2
|
||
&& mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
|
||
if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
|
||
{
|
||
extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
|
||
if (extension == base)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary. */
|
||
|
||
static bfd_boolean
|
||
mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
|
||
{
|
||
return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
|
||
|| (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
|
||
|| (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
|
||
|| (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
|
||
|| (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
|
||
|| (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
|
||
|| (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
|
||
object file when linking. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
|
||
{
|
||
flagword old_flags;
|
||
flagword new_flags;
|
||
bfd_boolean ok;
|
||
bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
|
||
asection *sec;
|
||
|
||
/* Check if we have the same endianess */
|
||
if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
|
||
{
|
||
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
||
(_("%s: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
|
||
bfd_archive_filename (ibfd));
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
|
||
|| bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
||
(_("%s: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
|
||
bfd_archive_filename (ibfd));
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
|
||
elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
|
||
old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
|
||
|
||
if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
|
||
{
|
||
elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
|
||
elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
|
||
elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
|
||
= elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
|
||
|
||
if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
|
||
&& bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
|
||
bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Check flag compatibility. */
|
||
|
||
new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
|
||
old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
|
||
|
||
/* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set. It
|
||
doesn't seem to matter. */
|
||
new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
|
||
old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
|
||
|
||
/* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects. Again, we should
|
||
just be able to ignore this. */
|
||
new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
|
||
old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
|
||
|
||
if (new_flags == old_flags)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
/* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections.
|
||
If not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it cannot
|
||
actually cause any incompatibility. */
|
||
for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
|
||
which are automatically generated by gas. */
|
||
if (strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
|
||
&& strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
|
||
&& (sec->_raw_size != 0
|
||
|| (strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
|
||
&& strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
|
||
&& strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))))
|
||
{
|
||
null_input_bfd = FALSE;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
if (null_input_bfd)
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
|
||
ok = TRUE;
|
||
|
||
if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
|
||
!= ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
|
||
{
|
||
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
||
(_("%s: warning: linking PIC files with non-PIC files"),
|
||
bfd_archive_filename (ibfd));
|
||
ok = TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
|
||
elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
|
||
if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
|
||
elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
|
||
|
||
new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
|
||
old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
|
||
|
||
/* Compare the ISAs. */
|
||
if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
|
||
{
|
||
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
||
(_("%s: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
|
||
bfd_archive_filename (ibfd));
|
||
ok = FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's. */
|
||
if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD. Also copy
|
||
the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
|
||
OBFD as a 32-bit binary. */
|
||
bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
|
||
elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
|
||
elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
|
||
|= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
|
||
|
||
/* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
|
||
and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit. */
|
||
if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
|
||
&& mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
|
||
&& !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
|
||
elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* The ISAs aren't compatible. */
|
||
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
||
(_("%s: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
|
||
bfd_archive_filename (ibfd),
|
||
bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
|
||
bfd_printable_name (obfd));
|
||
ok = FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
|
||
old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
|
||
|
||
/* Compare ABIs. The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI. But, it
|
||
does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI. */
|
||
if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
|
||
|| (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
|
||
!= elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Only error if both are set (to different values). */
|
||
if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
|
||
|| (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
|
||
!= elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
|
||
{
|
||
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
||
(_("%s: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
|
||
bfd_archive_filename (ibfd),
|
||
elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
|
||
elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
|
||
ok = FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
|
||
old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* For now, allow arbitrary mixing of ASEs (retain the union). */
|
||
if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
|
||
{
|
||
elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
|
||
|
||
new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
|
||
old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Warn about any other mismatches */
|
||
if (new_flags != old_flags)
|
||
{
|
||
(*_bfd_error_handler)
|
||
(_("%s: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules (0x%lx)"),
|
||
bfd_archive_filename (ibfd), (unsigned long) new_flags,
|
||
(unsigned long) old_flags);
|
||
ok = FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (! ok)
|
||
{
|
||
bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
|
||
return FALSE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC. */
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
|
||
{
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
|
||
|| elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
|
||
|
||
elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
|
||
elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
bfd_boolean
|
||
_bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
|
||
{
|
||
FILE *file = ptr;
|
||
|
||
BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Print normal ELF private data. */
|
||
_bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
|
||
|
||
/* xgettext:c-format */
|
||
fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
|
||
|
||
if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
|
||
else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
|
||
else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
|
||
else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
|
||
else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
|
||
else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
|
||
else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
|
||
else
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
|
||
|
||
if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [mips1]"));
|
||
else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [mips2]"));
|
||
else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [mips3]"));
|
||
else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [mips4]"));
|
||
else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [mips5]"));
|
||
else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [mips32]"));
|
||
else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [mips64]"));
|
||
else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [mips32r2]"));
|
||
else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [mips64r2]"));
|
||
else
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
|
||
|
||
if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [mdmx]"));
|
||
|
||
if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [mips16]"));
|
||
|
||
if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [32bitmode]"));
|
||
else
|
||
fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
|
||
|
||
fputc ('\n', file);
|
||
|
||
return TRUE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
struct bfd_elf_special_section const _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[]=
|
||
{
|
||
{ ".sdata", 6, -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
|
||
{ ".sbss", 5, -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
|
||
{ ".lit4", 5, 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
|
||
{ ".lit8", 5, 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
|
||
{ ".ucode", 6, 0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
|
||
{ ".mdebug", 7, 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
|
||
{ NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
|
||
};
|